1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname
\endcsname\relax\input plain
\fi
6 \def\texinfoversion{2012-
01-
19.16}
8 % Copyright 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
9 % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006,
10 % 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12 % This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or
13 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
14 % published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the
15 % License, or (at your option) any later version.
17 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
18 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
19 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
20 % General Public License for more details.
22 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
23 % along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
25 % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
26 % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
27 % restriction. (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.)
29 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
30 % reports; you can get the latest version from:
31 % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or
32 % ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex
33 % (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org).
34 % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
35 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
37 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a
38 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
39 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
41 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
42 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
43 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
48 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
49 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
50 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
51 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
53 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
54 % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
55 % full Texinfo distribution.
57 % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
60 \message{Loading texinfo
[version
\texinfoversion]:
}
62 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number
63 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
64 % they might have appeared in the input file name.
65 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version
\texinfoversion]}%
66 \catcode`+=
\active \catcode`
\_=
\active}
70 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
71 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
74 % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
76 \let\ptexbullet=
\bullet
84 \let\ptexfootnote=
\footnote
88 \let\ptexindent=
\indent
89 \let\ptexinsert=
\insert
92 \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
93 \let\ptexnoindent=
\noindent
95 \let\ptexraggedright=
\raggedright
101 {\catcode`\'=
\active \global\let\ptexquoteright'
}% active in plain's math mode
103 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
104 % starts a new line in the output.
107 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
108 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
110 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
111 \let\linenumber =
\empty % Pre-3.0.
113 \def\linenumber{l.
\the\inputlineno:
\space}
116 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
117 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix
}\fi
118 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter
}\fi
119 \ifx\putworderror\undefined \gdef\putworderror{error
}\fi
120 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file
}\fi
121 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in
}\fi
122 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)
}\fi
123 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)
}\fi
124 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info
}\fi
125 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of
}\fi
126 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on
}\fi
127 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title
}\fi
128 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of
}\fi
129 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on
}\fi
130 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page
}\fi
131 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section
}\fi
132 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section
}\fi
133 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see
}\fi
134 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See
}\fi
135 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents
}\fi
136 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents
}\fi
138 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January
}\fi
139 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February
}\fi
140 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March
}\fi
141 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April
}\fi
142 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May
}\fi
143 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June
}\fi
144 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July
}\fi
145 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August
}\fi
146 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September
}\fi
147 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October
}\fi
148 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November
}\fi
149 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December
}\fi
151 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro
}\fi
152 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form
}\fi
153 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable
}\fi
154 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option
}\fi
155 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function
}\fi
157 % Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful.
158 \chardef\spacecat =
10
159 \def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =
\spacecat}
161 % sometimes characters are active, so we need control sequences.
162 \chardef\ampChar = `\&
163 \chardef\colonChar = `\:
164 \chardef\commaChar = `\,
165 \chardef\dashChar = `\-
166 \chardef\dotChar = `\.
167 \chardef\exclamChar= `\!
168 \chardef\hashChar = `\#
169 \chardef\lquoteChar= `\`
170 \chardef\questChar = `\?
171 \chardef\rquoteChar= `\'
172 \chardef\semiChar = `\;
173 \chardef\slashChar = `\/
174 \chardef\underChar = `
\_
180 % The following is used inside several \edef's.
181 \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
185 Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
186 ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
187 data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
188 man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
189 par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
191 stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
192 wide-spread wrap-around
195 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
196 \newdimen\bindingoffset
197 \newdimen\normaloffset
198 \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
200 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles
201 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
202 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
204 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=
0pt
}
206 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
207 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
208 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
209 % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
210 % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
212 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs =
1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
216 \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
221 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
222 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined\else % etex gives us more logging
229 \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
233 % @errormsg{MSG}. Do the index-like expansions on MSG, but if things
234 % aren't perfect, it's not the end of the world, being an error message,
237 \def\errormsg{\begingroup \indexnofonts \doerrormsg}
238 \def\doerrormsg#1{\errmessage{#1}}
240 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
241 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
243 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<
\smallskipamount
244 \removelastskip\penalty-
50\smallskip\fi\fi}
245 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<
\medskipamount
246 \removelastskip\penalty-
100\medskip\fi\fi}
247 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<
\bigskipamount
248 \removelastskip\penalty-
200\bigskip\fi\fi}
250 % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
253 \let\cropmarks =
\cropmarkstrue
255 % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners.
256 % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986
258 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
259 \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=
1pc
260 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=
.3pt
261 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=
.75in
263 % Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor.
264 % We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark.
265 % This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark.
267 % A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct.
268 % \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase.
270 % Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter
271 % (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top
272 % of a page, or that at the bottom of a page. The solution is
273 % described on page 260 of The TeXbook. It involves outputting two
274 % marks for the sectioning macros, one before the section break, and
275 % one after. I won't pretend I can describe this better than DEK...
277 \toks0=
\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}%
278 \toks2=
\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}%
279 \toks4=
\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}%
280 \toks6=
\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}%
281 \toks8=
\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}%
283 \the\toks0 \the\toks2
284 \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6
285 \noexpand\else \the\toks8
288 % \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title
289 % page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us
290 % the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g.,
291 % @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very
293 \def\gettopheadingmarks{%
295 \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi
297 \def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi}
298 \def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi}
300 % Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors.
301 \def\lastchapterdefs{}
302 \def\lastsectiondefs{}
303 \def\prevchapterdefs{}
304 \def\prevsectiondefs{}
307 % Main output routine.
309 \output =
{\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
314 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents
315 % does insertions, but you have to call it yourself.
317 \ifcropmarks \hoffset=
0pt
\else \hoffset=
\normaloffset \fi
319 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by
\bindingoffset
320 \else \advance\hoffset by -
\bindingoffset\fi
322 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
323 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
324 \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
325 \setbox\headlinebox =
\vbox{\let\hsize=
\pagewidth \makeheadline}%
326 \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi
327 \setbox\footlinebox =
\vbox{\let\hsize=
\pagewidth \makefootline}%
330 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
331 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
332 % before the \shipout runs.
334 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
335 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
336 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
337 % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
338 % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
339 % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
341 % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym}
343 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
344 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name
{\the\pageno} xyz
\fi
346 \ifcropmarks \vbox to
\outervsize\bgroup
348 \vskip-
\topandbottommargin
350 \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}%
353 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}%
355 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}%
358 \vskip\topandbottommargin
360 \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize.
361 \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi
367 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox >
0pt
368 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
369 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
370 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
376 \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup
377 \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup
378 \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill
379 \boxmaxdepth =
\cornerthick
382 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}%
384 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}%
387 \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}%
389 \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
391 }% end of \shipout\vbox
392 }% end of group with \indexdummies
394 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-
20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
397 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=
\maxdimen
399 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to
\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=
\maxdepth #1}}
401 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
402 % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
403 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
404 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to
\z@
{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
405 \dimen@=
\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax
406 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
407 \ifr@ggedbottom
\kern-
\dimen@
\vfil \fi}
410 % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are
411 % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize
412 % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
414 \def\ewtop{\vrule height
\cornerthick depth0pt width
\cornerlong}
416 {\hrule height
\cornerthick depth
\cornerlong width
\cornerthick}}
417 \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth
\cornerthick width
\cornerlong}
419 {\hrule height
\cornerlong depth
\cornerthick width
\cornerthick}}
421 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
422 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
423 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
425 \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
426 \def\parseargusing#1#2{%
432 \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
436 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M
{%
437 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
438 \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
442 % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment.
443 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
444 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M
\ArgTerm}
446 % Each occurrence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
448 % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
449 % @end itemize @c foo
450 % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
451 % by \finishparsearg.
453 \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M
{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M
}
454 \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M
{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M
}
455 \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M
#2\^^M
#3\ArgTerm{%
458 % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
459 \let\temp\finishparsearg
461 \let\temp\argcheckspaces
463 % Put the space token in:
467 % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
468 % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
469 % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
470 % just before passing the control to \argtorun.
471 % (Similarly, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
472 % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
473 % that a pair of braces would be stripped.
475 % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
477 \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
479 % \parseargdef\foo{...}
480 % is roughly equivalent to
481 % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
484 % Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my
485 % favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03
488 \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
490 \def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
495 % Several utility definitions with active space:
500 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
501 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
502 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
503 % should produce a line of output anyway.
505 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =
\tie}
507 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
508 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
509 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
510 \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =
\space}
514 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next#
#1{}\else \let\next=
\relax \fi \next}
516 % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
521 % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
522 % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
523 % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
524 % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
525 % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
527 % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
528 % are not treated as environments; they don't open a group. (The
529 % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
533 % At run-time, environments start with this:
534 \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
538 % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
539 \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
540 \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
542 % Check whether we're in the right environment:
551 % Environment mismatch, #1 expected:
554 \errmessage{This command can appear only
\inenvironment\temp,
555 not
\inenvironment\thisenv}%
557 \def\inenvironment#1{%
559 outside of any environment
%
561 in environment
\expandafter\string#1%
565 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
566 % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
569 \if 1\csname iscond.
#1\endcsname
571 % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal.
572 \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
573 \csname E
#1\endcsname
578 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.
}
581 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
582 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
583 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
584 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
585 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
587 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
588 % if the definition is written into an index file.
589 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
590 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\
}
593 % @: forces normal size whitespace following.
594 \def\:
{\spacefactor=
1000 }
596 % @* forces a line break.
597 \def\*
{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
599 % @/ allows a line break.
602 % @. is an end-of-sentence period.
603 \def\.
{.
\spacefactor=
\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
605 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
606 \def\!
{!
\spacefactor=
\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
608 % @? is an end-of-sentence query.
609 \def\?
{?
\spacefactor=
\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
611 % @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
616 \parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
618 \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
619 \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
622 \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `
\temp', must be on|off
}%
626 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
627 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
628 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
629 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
631 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
632 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
633 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
634 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
635 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
636 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
637 % the text is small, which looks bad.
639 % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
640 % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
641 % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
642 % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
643 % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
644 % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
650 \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=
\active \else
651 \errhelp =
\groupinvalidhelp
652 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled
}%
656 \setbox\groupbox =
\vtop\bgroup
657 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
658 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
659 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
660 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
661 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
662 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
666 % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
667 % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
668 % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
669 % above. But it's pretty close.
671 % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
672 % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
673 \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
674 \global\dimen1 =
\prevdepth
675 \egroup % End the \vtop.
676 % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
677 \dimen0 =
\ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by
\dp\groupbox
678 % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
679 \dimen2 =
\pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -
\pagetotal
680 % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
681 % group, force a page break.
682 \ifdim \dimen0 >
\dimen2
683 \ifdim \pagetotal <
\vfilllimit\pageheight
692 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
693 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
695 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
696 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J
%
697 where each line of input produces a line of output.
}
699 % @need space-in-mils
700 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
702 \newdimen\mil \mil=
0.001in
705 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
709 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
711 \dimen2 =
\ht\strutbox
712 \advance\dimen2 by
\dp\strutbox
713 \ifdim\dimen0 >
\dimen2
715 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
716 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
717 % And a page break here is fine.
718 \vtop to
#1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
720 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
721 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
722 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
723 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
724 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
726 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
727 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
728 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
729 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
730 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
731 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
732 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
735 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
738 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
743 % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
747 % @page forces the start of a new page.
749 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
752 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
754 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
755 % That's how much \exdent should take out.
756 \newskip\exdentamount
758 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
759 \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -
\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
761 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
762 \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -
\exdentamount
763 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
765 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
766 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
767 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. Not documented, written for gawk manual.
769 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=
1cm
770 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
772 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
775 \vtop to
\strutdepth{%
776 \baselineskip=
\strutdepth
778 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
779 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
781 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
783 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
788 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l
}
789 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r
}
791 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
792 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
793 % else use TEXT for both).
795 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,
\finish}
796 \def\parseinmargin#1,
#2,
#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
797 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
799 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
802 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
807 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
809 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
814 % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
815 % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
816 % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
817 % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
818 % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change). This command
819 % is not documented, not supported, and doesn't work.
822 % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
825 % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
827 % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
828 % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
831 % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
832 % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
835 % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
836 \vrule height
\baselineskip width1pt
838 % This is the space between the bar and the text.
844 % @include FILE -- \input text of FILE.
846 \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
851 \makevalueexpandable % we want to expand any @value in FILE.
852 \turnoffactive % and allow special characters in the expansion
853 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
854 \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @include of
#1^^J
}%
855 \edef\temp{\noexpand\input #1 }%
857 % This trickery is to read FILE outside of a group, in case it makes
863 \def\filenamecatcodes{%
877 \def\pushthisfilestack{%
878 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
880 \def\pushthisfilestackX{%
881 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
883 \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
884 \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
887 \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
888 \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
889 the stack of filenames is empty.
}}
894 % outputs that line, centered.
896 \parseargdef\center{%
902 \next{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
907 \advance\hsize by -
\leftskip
908 \advance\hsize by -
\rightskip
913 \def\centerV#1{\line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}}
915 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
917 \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
919 % @comment ...line which is ignored...
920 % @c is the same as @comment
921 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
923 \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=
\other%
924 \catcode`\@=
\other \catcode`\
{=
\other \catcode`\
}=
\other%
926 {\catcode`\^^M=
\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M
{\endgroup}}
930 % @paragraphindent NCHARS
931 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
932 % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
933 % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
935 \def\asisword{asis
} % no translation, these are keywords
938 \parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
943 \defaultparindent =
0pt
945 \defaultparindent =
#1em
948 \parindent =
\defaultparindent
951 % @exampleindent NCHARS
952 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
953 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
954 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
955 \parseargdef\exampleindent{%
962 \lispnarrowing =
#1em
967 % @firstparagraphindent WORD
968 % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
969 % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
972 % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
973 % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
974 % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
975 % By default, we suppress indentation.
977 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
978 \def\insertword{insert
}
980 \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
983 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent =
\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
984 \else\ifx\temp\insertword
985 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent =
\relax
988 \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `
\temp'
}%
992 % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
993 % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
995 % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
998 \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
1000 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1004 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1007 \global\everypar =
{%
1009 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1013 \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
1014 \global \let \indent =
\ptexindent
1015 \global \let \noindent =
\ptexnoindent
1016 \global \everypar =
{}%
1020 % @refill is a no-op.
1023 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
1024 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
1025 % This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename).
1027 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
1028 \let\novalidate =
\linksfalse
1030 % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file.
1031 % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input.
1032 % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo.
1034 \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
1037 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
1038 \immediate\openout\auxfile=
\jobname.aux
1039 \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case.
1041 \let\setfilename=
\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
1043 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
1044 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc.
1045 \openin 1 texinfo.cnf
1046 \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf
\fi
1049 \comment % Ignore the actual filename.
1052 % Called from \setfilename.
1064 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=
1\ptexend}
1068 % adobe `portable' document format
1072 \newcount\filenamelength
1081 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
1083 % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
1084 % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as being undefined.
1085 \ifx\pdfoutput\thisisundefined
1087 \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
1096 % PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
1097 % for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
1098 % double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
1099 % interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
1101 % See http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html and
1102 % related messages. The final outcome is that it is up to the TeX user
1103 % to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
1104 % that's what we do. pdftex 1.30.0 (ca.2005) introduced a primitive to
1105 % do this reliably, so we use it.
1107 % #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements,
1109 \def\txiescapepdf#1{%
1110 \ifx\pdfescapestring\relax
1111 % No primitive available; should we give a warning or log?
1112 % Many times it won't matter.
1114 % The expandable \pdfescapestring primitive escapes parentheses,
1115 % backslashes, and other special chars.
1116 \xdef#1{\pdfescapestring{#1}}%
1120 \newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
1121 with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot
1122 be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
1127 % Color manipulation macros based on pdfcolor.tex,
1128 % except using rgb instead of cmyk; the latter is said to render as a
1129 % very dark gray on-screen and a very dark halftone in print, instead
1131 \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12}
1132 \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0}
1134 % k sets the color for filling (usual text, etc.);
1135 % K sets the color for stroking (thin rules, e.g., normal _'s).
1136 \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 rg
#1 RG
}}
1138 % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
1139 % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
1141 \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
1146 \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack}
1147 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
1148 \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
1149 \def\lastcolordefs{}
1153 \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
1161 % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
1163 % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
1164 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
1172 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines
}
1174 % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
1175 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
1176 \def\imagewidth{#2}\setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
1177 \def\imageheight{#3}\setbox2 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
1179 % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .pdf, .png, .jpg (among
1180 % others). Let's try in that order, PDF first since if
1181 % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a
1183 \let\pdfimgext=
\empty
1185 \openin 1 #1.pdf
\ifeof 1
1186 \openin 1 #1.PDF
\ifeof 1
1187 \openin 1 #1.png
\ifeof 1
1188 \openin 1 #1.jpg
\ifeof 1
1189 \openin 1 #1.jpeg
\ifeof 1
1190 \openin 1 #1.JPG
\ifeof 1
1191 \errhelp =
\nopdfimagehelp
1192 \errmessage{Could not find image file
#1 for pdf
}%
1193 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG
}%
1195 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg
}%
1197 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg
}%
1199 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png
}%
1201 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{PDF
}%
1203 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf
}%
1208 % without \immediate, ancient pdftex seg faults when the same image is
1209 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
1210 \ifnum\pdftexversion <
14
1213 \immediate\pdfximage
1215 \ifdim \wd0 >
0pt width
\imagewidth \fi
1216 \ifdim \wd2 >
0pt height
\imageheight \fi
1217 \ifnum\pdftexversion<
13
1222 \ifnum\pdftexversion <
14 \else
1223 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
1227 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
1228 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
1231 \makevalueexpandable
1232 \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
1233 \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname
1234 \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name
{\pdfdestname} xyz
}%
1237 % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
1240 % by default, use a color that is dark enough to print on paper as
1241 % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing.
1242 \def\urlcolor{\rgbDarkRed}
1243 \def\linkcolor{\rgbDarkRed}
1244 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
1246 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
1247 % come from Petr Olsak
1248 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
1249 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
1250 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=
\expnumber{#1}\relax
1251 \advance\tempnum by
1
1252 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
1254 % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
1255 % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
1256 % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
1257 % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
1258 % #4 is the page number
1260 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
1261 % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
1262 % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
1263 % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
1264 % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
1265 \edef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
1266 \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty
1267 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}%
1269 \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinedest
1272 % Also escape PDF chars in the display string.
1273 \edef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1274 \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinetext
1276 \pdfoutline goto name
{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
1279 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
1281 % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
1282 \def\partentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{}% ignore parts in the outlines
1283 \def\numchapentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1284 \def\thischapnum{#
#2}%
1286 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1288 \def\numsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1289 \advancenumber{chap
\thischapnum}%
1290 \def\thissecnum{#
#2}%
1291 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1293 \def\numsubsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1294 \advancenumber{sec
\thissecnum}%
1295 \def\thissubsecnum{#
#2}%
1297 \def\numsubsubsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1298 \advancenumber{subsec
\thissubsecnum}%
1300 \def\thischapnum{0}%
1302 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1304 % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
1305 % al. a second time, below.
1306 \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
1307 \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1308 \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1309 \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1310 \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
1311 \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1312 \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1313 \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1316 % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
1317 % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
1318 % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
1320 % We use the node names as the destinations.
1321 \def\numchapentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1322 \dopdfoutline{#
#1}{count-
\expnumber{chap#
#2}}{#
#3}{#
#4}}%
1323 \def\numsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1324 \dopdfoutline{#
#1}{count-
\expnumber{sec#
#2}}{#
#3}{#
#4}}%
1325 \def\numsubsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
1326 \dopdfoutline{#
#1}{count-
\expnumber{subsec#
#2}}{#
#3}{#
#4}}%
1327 \def\numsubsubsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{% count is always zero
1328 \dopdfoutline{#
#1}{}{#
#3}{#
#4}}%
1330 % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
1331 % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
1332 % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
1333 % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
1334 % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
1336 % TODO this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
1337 % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Too
1338 % much work for too little return. Just use the ASCII equivalents
1339 % we use for the index sort strings.
1343 % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike
1344 % Texinfo index files. So set that up.
1345 \def\
{{\lbracecharliteral}%
1346 \def\
}{\rbracecharliteral}%
1347 \catcode`\\=
\active \otherbackslash
1348 \input \tocreadfilename
1351 {\catcode`
[=
1 \catcode`
]=
2
1352 \catcode`
{=
\other \catcode`
}=
\other
1353 \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]%
1354 \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]%
1357 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|
}%
1358 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
1359 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
1360 \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
1361 \advance\filenamelength by
1
1365 \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=
0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|
\relax}
1366 \ifnum\pdftexversion <
14
1367 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
1369 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
1371 % make a live url in pdf output.
1374 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
1375 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
1376 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
1377 % people have actually reported a problem with.
1379 \normalturnoffactive
1382 \makevalueexpandable
1383 % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just
1384 % special-casing \var here?
1387 \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
1388 \startlink attr
{/Border
[0 0 0]}%
1389 user
{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (
#1) >>
}%
1391 \def\pdfgettoks#1.
{\setbox\boxA=
\hbox{\toksA=
{#1.
}\toksB=
{}\maketoks}}
1392 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1=
{\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
1393 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=
1\let\next=
\maketoks}
1394 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|
{\let\first=
#1\toksD=
{#1}\toksA=
{#2}}
1396 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|
\relax
1398 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
1399 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
1400 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
1402 \ifnum0=
\countA\else\makelink\fi
1403 \ifx\first.
\let\next=
\done\else
1405 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
1406 \ifx\first,
\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
1408 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
1410 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
1411 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC=
{}\global\countA=
0}
1413 \startlink attr
{/Border
[0 0 0]} goto name
{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
1414 \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
1415 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA=
{\the\toksB}}\st}
1418 \let\pdfmkdest =
\gobble
1419 \let\pdfurl =
\gobble
1420 \let\endlink =
\relax
1421 \let\setcolor =
\gobble
1422 \let\pdfsetcolor =
\gobble
1423 \let\pdfmakeoutlines =
\relax
1424 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
1429 % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
1430 % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
1431 % italics, not bold italics.
1433 \def\setfontstyle#1{%
1434 \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
1435 \csname ten
#1\endcsname % change the current font
1438 % Select #1 fonts with the current style.
1440 \def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts
\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname}
1442 \def\rm{\fam=
0 \setfontstyle{rm
}}
1443 \def\it{\fam=
\itfam \setfontstyle{it
}}
1444 \def\sl{\fam=
\slfam \setfontstyle{sl
}}
1445 \def\bf{\fam=
\bffam \setfontstyle{bf
}}\def\bfstylename{bf
}
1446 \def\tt{\fam=
\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt
}}
1448 % Unfortunately, we have to override this for titles and the like, since
1449 % in those cases "rm" is bold. Sigh.
1450 \def\rmisbold{\rm\def\curfontstyle{bf
}}
1452 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
1453 % So we set up a \sf.
1455 \def\sf{\fam=
\sffam \setfontstyle{sf
}}
1456 \let\li =
\sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf.
1458 % We don't need math for this font style.
1459 \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl
}}
1463 \newdimen\textleading \textleading =
13.2pt
1465 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
1466 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
1467 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
1469 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
1470 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
1471 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
1473 % can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this.
1474 \def\baselinefactor{1}
1478 \normalbaselineskip =
\baselinefactor\dimen0
1479 \normallineskip =
\lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
1481 \setbox\strutbox =
\hbox{%
1482 \vrule width0pt height
\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
1483 depth
\strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
1487 % PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
1489 % do nothing with this by default.
1490 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1
\endcsname\gobble
1491 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT
\endcsname\gobble
1492 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT
\endcsname\gobble
1494 % if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps.
1495 % (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run
1496 % older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.)
1497 \ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\thisisundefined \else
1499 \catcode`\^^M=
\active \def^^M
{^^J
}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1500 \catcode`\%=
12 \immediate\pdfobj stream
{%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1501 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1502 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1503 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
1504 %%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
1507 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1515 /CMapName /TeX-OT1-
0 def
1517 1 begincodespacerange
1573 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1579 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1
\endcsname#1{%
1580 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode
\the\pdflastobj\space 0 R
}%
1585 \catcode`\^^M=
\active \def^^M
{^^J
}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1586 \catcode`\%=
12 \immediate\pdfobj stream
{%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1587 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1588 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1589 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
1590 %%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
1593 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1601 /CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-
0 def
1603 1 begincodespacerange
1661 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1667 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT
\endcsname#1{%
1668 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode
\the\pdflastobj\space 0 R
}%
1673 \catcode`\^^M=
\active \def^^M
{^^J
}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1674 \catcode`\%=
12 \immediate\pdfobj stream
{%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1675 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1676 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1677 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
1678 %%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
1681 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1689 /CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-
0 def
1691 1 begincodespacerange
1736 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1742 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT
\endcsname#1{%
1743 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode
\the\pdflastobj\space 0 R
}%
1748 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the
1749 % specified font prefix (normally `cm').
1750 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
1751 % encoding (currently only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, pass
1753 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
1754 \font#1=
\fontprefix#2#3 scaled
#4
1755 \csname cmap
#5\endcsname#1%
1757 % This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
1759 % emacs-page end of cmaps
1761 % Use cm as the default font prefix.
1762 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
1763 % before you read in texinfo.tex.
1764 \ifx\fontprefix\thisisundefined
1767 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
1769 \def\rmbshape{bx
} %where the normal face is bold
1774 \def\ttslshape{sltt
}
1784 % Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. This is the default in
1787 \def\definetextfontsizexi{%
1788 % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
1789 \def\textnominalsize{11pt
}
1790 \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
1791 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1792 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT
}
1793 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1794 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT
}
1795 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1796 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1797 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1798 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT
}
1799 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled
\mainmagstep
1800 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled
\mainmagstep
1801 \def\textecsize{1095}
1803 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
1804 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1805 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
1806 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
1807 \def\df{\let\tentt=
\deftt \let\tenbf =
\defbf \let\tenttsl=
\defttsl \bf}
1809 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
1810 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt
}
1811 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1812 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1813 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
1814 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT
}
1815 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1816 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1817 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
1818 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT
}
1821 \def\smallecsize{0900}
1823 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
1824 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt
}
1825 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
1826 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1827 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1
}
1828 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT
}
1829 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
1830 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
1831 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1
}
1832 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT
}
1833 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
1834 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
1835 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
1837 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
1838 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt
}
1839 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1
}
1840 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT
}
1841 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1
}
1842 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT
}
1843 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT
}
1844 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1845 \let\titlebf=
\titlerm
1846 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1
}
1847 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep3
1848 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep4
1849 \def\titleecsize{2074}
1851 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
1852 \def\chapnominalsize{17pt
}
1853 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
1854 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT
}
1855 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1
}
1856 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT
}
1857 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT
}
1858 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1
}
1860 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1
}
1861 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep2
1862 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep3
1863 \def\chapecsize{1728}
1865 % Section fonts (14.4pt).
1866 \def\secnominalsize{14pt
}
1867 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1868 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT
}
1869 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
1870 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
1871 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT
}
1872 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1874 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
1875 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep1
1876 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep2
1877 \def\sececsize{1440}
1879 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
1880 \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt
}
1881 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1
}
1882 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT
}
1883 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1
}
1884 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT
}
1885 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT
}
1886 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1
}
1888 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1
}
1889 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled
\magstephalf
1890 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled
1315
1891 \def\ssececsize{1200}
1893 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt).
1894 \def\reducednominalsize{10pt
}
1895 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
1896 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1897 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
1898 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT
}
1899 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
1900 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
1901 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
1902 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1903 \font\reducedi=cmmi10
1904 \font\reducedsy=cmsy10
1905 \def\reducedecsize{1000}
1907 \textleading =
13.2pt
% line spacing for 11pt CM
1908 \textfonts % reset the current fonts
1910 } % end of 11pt text font size definitions
1913 % Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
1914 % section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU
1915 % Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the
1916 % future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
1918 \def\definetextfontsizex{%
1919 % Text fonts (10pt).
1920 \def\textnominalsize{10pt
}
1921 \edef\mainmagstep{1000}
1922 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1923 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT
}
1924 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1925 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT
}
1926 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1927 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1928 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1
}
1929 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT
}
1930 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled
\mainmagstep
1931 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled
\mainmagstep
1932 \def\textecsize{1000}
1934 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
1935 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1
}
1936 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT
}
1937 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT
}
1938 \def\df{\let\tentt=
\deftt \let\tenbf =
\defbf \let\tenttsl=
\defttsl \bf}
1940 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
1941 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt
}
1942 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1943 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1944 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
1945 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT
}
1946 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1947 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
1948 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
1949 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT
}
1952 \def\smallecsize{0900}
1954 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
1955 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt
}
1956 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
1957 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT
}
1958 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1
}
1959 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT
}
1960 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
1961 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1
}
1962 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1
}
1963 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT
}
1964 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
1965 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
1966 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
1968 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
1969 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt
}
1970 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1
}
1971 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT
}
1972 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1
}
1973 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT
}
1974 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT
}
1975 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1976 \let\titlebf=
\titlerm
1977 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1
}
1978 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep3
1979 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep4
1980 \def\titleecsize{2074}
1982 % Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
1983 \def\chapnominalsize{14pt
}
1984 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1985 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT
}
1986 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
1987 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
1988 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT
}
1989 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
1991 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1
}
1992 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled
\magstep1
1993 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep2
1994 \def\chapecsize{1440}
1996 % Section fonts (12pt).
1997 \def\secnominalsize{12pt
}
1998 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1
}
1999 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT
}
2000 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2001 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2002 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT
}
2003 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1
}
2005 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1
}
2007 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled
\magstep1
2008 \def\sececsize{1200}
2010 % Subsection fonts (10pt).
2011 \def\ssecnominalsize{10pt
}
2012 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2013 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT
}
2014 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2015 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2016 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2017 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2019 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1
}
2022 \def\ssececsize{1000}
2024 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (9pt).
2025 \def\reducednominalsize{9pt
}
2026 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2027 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2028 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
2029 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT
}
2030 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2031 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1
}
2032 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1
}
2033 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT
}
2034 \font\reducedi=cmmi9
2035 \font\reducedsy=cmsy9
2036 \def\reducedecsize{0900}
2038 \divide\parskip by
2 % reduce space between paragraphs
2039 \textleading =
12pt
% line spacing for 10pt CM
2040 \textfonts % reset the current fonts
2042 } % end of 10pt text font size definitions
2045 % We provide the user-level command
2047 % (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed.
2053 \parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
2054 \def\textsizearg{#1}%
2055 %\wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
2057 % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
2058 % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
2060 \begingroup \globaldefs=
1
2061 \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
2062 \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
2065 \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `
10' or `
11', not `
\textsizearg'
}
2071 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
2072 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since
2073 % texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except
2074 % in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and
2075 % \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts).
2077 \def\resetmathfonts{%
2078 \textfont0=
\tenrm \textfont1=
\teni \textfont2=
\tensy
2079 \textfont\itfam=
\tenit \textfont\slfam=
\tensl \textfont\bffam=
\tenbf
2080 \textfont\ttfam=
\tentt \textfont\sffam=
\tensf
2083 % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead
2084 % of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the
2085 % current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire
2086 % \tenSTYLE to set the current font.
2088 % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
2089 % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in
2090 % the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
2092 % This all needs generalizing, badly.
2095 \let\tenrm=
\textrm \let\tenit=
\textit \let\tensl=
\textsl
2096 \let\tenbf=
\textbf \let\tentt=
\texttt \let\smallcaps=
\textsc
2097 \let\tensf=
\textsf \let\teni=
\texti \let\tensy=
\textsy
2098 \let\tenttsl=
\textttsl
2099 \def\curfontsize{text
}%
2100 \def\lsize{reduced
}\def\lllsize{smaller
}%
2101 \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}}
2103 \let\tenrm=
\titlerm \let\tenit=
\titleit \let\tensl=
\titlesl
2104 \let\tenbf=
\titlebf \let\tentt=
\titlett \let\smallcaps=
\titlesc
2105 \let\tensf=
\titlesf \let\teni=
\titlei \let\tensy=
\titlesy
2106 \let\tenttsl=
\titlettsl
2107 \def\curfontsize{title
}%
2108 \def\lsize{chap
}\def\lllsize{subsec
}%
2109 \resetmathfonts \setleading{27pt
}}
2110 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rmisbold #1}}
2112 \let\tenrm=
\chaprm \let\tenit=
\chapit \let\tensl=
\chapsl
2113 \let\tenbf=
\chapbf \let\tentt=
\chaptt \let\smallcaps=
\chapsc
2114 \let\tensf=
\chapsf \let\teni=
\chapi \let\tensy=
\chapsy
2115 \let\tenttsl=
\chapttsl
2116 \def\curfontsize{chap
}%
2117 \def\lsize{sec
}\def\lllsize{text
}%
2118 \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt
}}
2120 \let\tenrm=
\secrm \let\tenit=
\secit \let\tensl=
\secsl
2121 \let\tenbf=
\secbf \let\tentt=
\sectt \let\smallcaps=
\secsc
2122 \let\tensf=
\secsf \let\teni=
\seci \let\tensy=
\secsy
2123 \let\tenttsl=
\secttsl
2124 \def\curfontsize{sec
}%
2125 \def\lsize{subsec
}\def\lllsize{reduced
}%
2126 \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt
}}
2128 \let\tenrm=
\ssecrm \let\tenit=
\ssecit \let\tensl=
\ssecsl
2129 \let\tenbf=
\ssecbf \let\tentt=
\ssectt \let\smallcaps=
\ssecsc
2130 \let\tensf=
\ssecsf \let\teni=
\sseci \let\tensy=
\ssecsy
2131 \let\tenttsl=
\ssecttsl
2132 \def\curfontsize{ssec
}%
2133 \def\lsize{text
}\def\lllsize{small
}%
2134 \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt
}}
2135 \let\subsubsecfonts =
\subsecfonts
2137 \let\tenrm=
\reducedrm \let\tenit=
\reducedit \let\tensl=
\reducedsl
2138 \let\tenbf=
\reducedbf \let\tentt=
\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=
\reducedsc
2139 \let\tensf=
\reducedsf \let\teni=
\reducedi \let\tensy=
\reducedsy
2140 \let\tenttsl=
\reducedttsl
2141 \def\curfontsize{reduced
}%
2142 \def\lsize{small
}\def\lllsize{smaller
}%
2143 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt
}}
2145 \let\tenrm=
\smallrm \let\tenit=
\smallit \let\tensl=
\smallsl
2146 \let\tenbf=
\smallbf \let\tentt=
\smalltt \let\smallcaps=
\smallsc
2147 \let\tensf=
\smallsf \let\teni=
\smalli \let\tensy=
\smallsy
2148 \let\tenttsl=
\smallttsl
2149 \def\curfontsize{small
}%
2150 \def\lsize{smaller
}\def\lllsize{smaller
}%
2151 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt
}}
2153 \let\tenrm=
\smallerrm \let\tenit=
\smallerit \let\tensl=
\smallersl
2154 \let\tenbf=
\smallerbf \let\tentt=
\smallertt \let\smallcaps=
\smallersc
2155 \let\tensf=
\smallersf \let\teni=
\smalleri \let\tensy=
\smallersy
2156 \let\tenttsl=
\smallerttsl
2157 \def\curfontsize{smaller
}%
2158 \def\lsize{smaller
}\def\lllsize{smaller
}%
2159 \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt
}}
2161 % Fonts for short table of contents.
2162 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1
}
2163 \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1
} % no cmb12
2164 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1
}
2165 \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT
}
2167 % Define these just so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
2168 \def\angleleft{$
\langle$
}
2169 \def\angleright{$
\rangle$
}
2171 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
2172 \let\smallexamplefonts =
\smallfonts
2174 % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
2175 % can fit this many characters:
2176 % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
2177 % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
2178 % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
2179 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
2180 % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
2182 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
2183 % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
2186 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
2188 \definetextfontsizexi
2193 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
2194 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
2195 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
2196 % this property, we can check that font parameter.
2198 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=
0pt
}
2200 % Markup style infrastructure. \defmarkupstylesetup\INITMACRO will
2201 % define and register \INITMACRO to be called on markup style changes.
2202 % \INITMACRO can check \currentmarkupstyle for the innermost
2203 % style and the set of \ifmarkupSTYLE switches for all styles
2204 % currently in effect.
2208 %\newif\ifmarkupfile % @file == @samp.
2209 %\newif\ifmarkupoption % @option == @samp.
2212 %\newif\ifmarkupenv % @env == @code.
2213 %\newif\ifmarkupcommand % @command == @code.
2214 \newif\ifmarkuptex % @tex (and part of @math, for now).
2215 \newif\ifmarkupexample
2217 \newif\ifmarkupverbatim
2219 \let\currentmarkupstyle\empty
2221 \def\setupmarkupstyle#1{%
2222 \csname markup
#1true
\endcsname
2223 \def\currentmarkupstyle{#1}%
2227 \let\markupstylesetup\empty
2229 \def\defmarkupstylesetup#1{%
2230 \expandafter\def\expandafter\markupstylesetup
2231 \expandafter{\markupstylesetup #1}%
2235 % Markup style setup for left and right quotes.
2236 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuplq{%
2237 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
2238 \csname markupsetuplq
\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
2239 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuplqdefault \else \temp \fi
2242 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuprq{%
2243 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
2244 \csname markupsetuprq
\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
2245 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuprqdefault \else \temp \fi
2252 \gdef\markupsetuplqdefault{\let`
\lq}
2253 \gdef\markupsetuprqdefault{\let'
\rq}
2255 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteleft{\let`
\codequoteleft}
2256 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteright{\let'
\codequoteright}
2258 \gdef\markupsetnoligaturesquoteleft{\let`
\noligaturesquoteleft}
2261 \let\markupsetuplqcode \markupsetcodequoteleft
2262 \let\markupsetuprqcode \markupsetcodequoteright
2264 \let\markupsetuplqexample \markupsetcodequoteleft
2265 \let\markupsetuprqexample \markupsetcodequoteright
2267 \let\markupsetuplqsamp \markupsetcodequoteleft
2268 \let\markupsetuprqsamp \markupsetcodequoteright
2270 \let\markupsetuplqverb \markupsetcodequoteleft
2271 \let\markupsetuprqverb \markupsetcodequoteright
2273 \let\markupsetuplqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteleft
2274 \let\markupsetuprqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteright
2276 \let\markupsetuplqkbd \markupsetnoligaturesquoteleft
2278 % Allow an option to not use regular directed right quote/apostrophe
2279 % (char 0x27), but instead the undirected quote from cmtt (char 0x0d).
2280 % The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it the default, but it
2281 % works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least evince), the
2282 % lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the regular 0x27.
2284 \def\codequoteright{%
2285 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected
\endcsname\relax
2286 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected
\endcsname\relax
2292 % and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
2293 % Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
2294 % the code environments to do likewise.
2296 \def\codequoteleft{%
2297 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick
\endcsname\relax
2298 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick
\endcsname\relax
2299 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
2300 % \relax disables Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
2306 % Commands to set the quote options.
2308 \parseargdef\codequoteundirected{%
2311 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected
\endcsname
2313 \else\ifx\temp\offword
2314 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected
\endcsname
2317 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
2318 \errmessage{Unknown @codequoteundirected value `
\temp', must be on|off
}%
2322 \parseargdef\codequotebacktick{%
2325 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick
\endcsname
2327 \else\ifx\temp\offword
2328 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick
\endcsname
2331 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
2332 \errmessage{Unknown @codequotebacktick value `
\temp', must be on|off
}%
2336 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391, disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
2337 \def\noligaturesquoteleft{\relax\lq}
2339 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
2340 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=
0
2344 % #1 is the font command (\sl or \it), #2 is the text to slant.
2345 % If we are in a monospaced environment, however, 1) always use \ttsl,
2346 % and 2) do not add an italic correction.
2347 \def\dosmartslant#1#2{%
2349 {{\ttsl #2}\let\next=
\relax}%
2350 {\def\next{{#1#2}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}}%
2353 \def\smartslanted{\dosmartslant\sl}
2354 \def\smartitalic{\dosmartslant\it}
2356 % Output an italic correction unless \next (presumed to be the following
2357 % character) is such as not to need one.
2358 \def\smartitaliccorrection{%
2367 % like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl, and no ic.
2368 % @var is set to this for defun arguments.
2369 \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}}
2371 % @cite is like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
2372 % ttsl for book titles, do we?
2373 \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}
2377 \let\saveaftersmartic =
\aftersmartic
2378 \def\aftersmartic{\null\let\aftersmartic=
\saveaftersmartic}%
2383 \let\slanted=
\smartslanted
2384 \let\dfn=
\smartslanted
2385 \let\emph=
\smartitalic
2387 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
2388 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
2389 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
2390 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
2392 % @b, explicit bold. Also @strong.
2396 % @sansserif, explicit sans.
2397 \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
2399 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
2400 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
2401 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
2403 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -
1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
2404 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `-
}
2406 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
2407 % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
2408 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
2411 \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
2412 \sfcode\dotChar =\@m
\sfcode\questChar=\@m
\sfcode\exclamChar=\@m
2413 \sfcode\colonChar=\@m
\sfcode\semiChar =\@m
\sfcode\commaChar =\@m
2414 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
2416 \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
2417 \sfcode`\
.3000\sfcode`\?
3000\sfcode`\!
3000
2418 \sfcode`\:
2000\sfcode`\;
1500\sfcode`\,
1250
2419 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
2422 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
2424 % @t, explicit typewriter.
2426 {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2431 \def\samp#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{samp
}\lq\tclose{#1}\rq\null}}
2433 % definition of @key that produces a lozenge. Doesn't adjust to text size.
2434 %\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2436 %\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
2437 % \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
2438 % \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
2439 % \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
2440 % \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
2441 % \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
2443 % definition of @key with no lozenge. If the current font is already
2444 % monospace, don't change it; that way, we respect @kbdinputstyle. But
2445 % if it isn't monospace, then use \tt.
2447 \def\key#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{key
}%
2449 \ifmonospace\else\tt\fi
2452 % ctrl is no longer a Texinfo command.
2453 \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1}
2455 % @file, @option are the same as @samp.
2459 % @code is a modification of @t,
2460 % which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text.
2463 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
2464 \spaceskip =
\fontdimen2\font
2466 % Switch to typewriter.
2469 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
2470 \def\
{{\spaceskip =
0pt
{} }}%
2472 % Turn off hyphenation.
2479 \null % reset spacefactor to 1000
2482 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
2483 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
2484 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
2486 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
2487 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
2488 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
2489 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash.
2492 \catcode`\-=
\active \catcode`
\_=
\active
2493 \catcode`\'=
\active \catcode`\`=
\active
2494 \global\let'=
\rq \global\let`=
\lq % default definitions
2496 \global\def\code{\begingroup
2497 \setupmarkupstyle{code
}%
2498 % The following should really be moved into \setupmarkupstyle handlers.
2499 \catcode\dashChar=
\active \catcode\underChar=
\active
2511 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
2514 \def\codedash{-
\discretionary{}{}{}}
2516 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
2517 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
2518 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
2519 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
2521 \mathchar"
075F
% class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
2522 \else\normalunderscore \fi
2523 \discretionary{}{}{}}%
2527 % An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
2528 % each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is undesirable in
2529 % some manuals, especially if they don't have long identifiers in
2530 % general. @allowcodebreaks provides a way to control this.
2532 \newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
2534 \def\keywordtrue{true
}
2535 \def\keywordfalse{false
}
2537 \parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
2539 \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
2540 \allowcodebreakstrue
2541 \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
2542 \allowcodebreaksfalse
2544 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
2545 \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `
\txiarg', must be true|false
}%
2549 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated)
2550 % second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third
2551 % arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url
2552 % itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url.
2553 % (This \urefnobreak definition isn't used now, leaving it for a while
2555 \def\urefnobreak#1{\dourefnobreak #1,,,
\finish}
2556 \def\dourefnobreak#1,
#2,
#3,
#4\finish{\begingroup
2559 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
2561 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
2563 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2566 \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it
2568 \unhbox0\ (
\code{#1})
% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url
2571 \code{#1}% only url given, so show it
2577 % This \urefbreak definition is the active one.
2578 \def\urefbreak{\begingroup \urefcatcodes \dourefbreak}
2579 \let\uref=
\urefbreak
2580 \def\dourefbreak#1{\urefbreakfinish #1,,,
\finish}
2581 \def\urefbreakfinish#1,
#2,
#3,
#4\finish{% doesn't work in @example
2584 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
2586 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
2588 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2591 \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it
2593 \unhbox0\ (
\urefcode{#1})
% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url
2596 \urefcode{#1}% only url given, so show it
2602 % Allow line breaks around only a few characters (only).
2604 \catcode\ampChar=
\active \catcode\dotChar=
\active
2605 \catcode\hashChar=
\active \catcode\questChar=
\active
2606 \catcode\slashChar=
\active
2611 \global\def\urefcode{\begingroup
2612 \setupmarkupstyle{code
}%
2622 % By default, they are just regular characters.
2623 \global\def&
{\normalamp}
2624 \global\def.
{\normaldot}
2625 \global\def#
{\normalhash}
2626 \global\def?
{\normalquest}
2627 \global\def/
{\normalslash}
2630 % we put a little stretch before and after the breakable chars, to help
2631 % line breaking of long url's. The unequal skips make look better in
2632 % cmtt at least, especially for dots.
2633 \def\urefprestretch{\urefprebreak \hskip0pt plus
.13em
}
2634 \def\urefpoststretch{\urefpostbreak \hskip0pt plus
.1em
}
2636 \def\urefcodeamp{\urefprestretch \&
\urefpoststretch}
2637 \def\urefcodedot{\urefprestretch .
\urefpoststretch}
2638 \def\urefcodehash{\urefprestretch \#
\urefpoststretch}
2639 \def\urefcodequest{\urefprestretch ?
\urefpoststretch}
2640 \def\urefcodeslash{\futurelet\next\urefcodeslashfinish}
2643 \global\def\urefcodeslashfinish{%
2644 \urefprestretch \slashChar
2645 % Allow line break only after the final / in a sequence of
2646 % slashes, to avoid line break between the slashes in http://.
2647 \ifx\next/
\else \urefpoststretch \fi
2651 % One more complication: by default we'll break after the special
2652 % characters, but some people like to break before the special chars, so
2653 % allow that. Also allow no breaking at all, for manual control.
2655 \parseargdef\urefbreakstyle{%
2657 \ifx\txiarg\wordnone
2658 \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
2659 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordbefore
2660 \def\urefprebreak{\allowbreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
2661 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordafter
2662 \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\allowbreak}
2664 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
2665 \errmessage{Unknown @urefbreakstyle setting `
\txiarg'
}%
2668 \def\wordafter{after
}
2669 \def\wordbefore{before
}
2672 \urefbreakstyle after
2674 % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
2678 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
2679 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
2681 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
2683 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,
\finish}
2684 \def\doemail#1,
#2,
#3\finish{\begingroup
2687 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2688 \ifdim\wd0>
0pt
\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
2695 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
2696 % then @kbd has no effect.
2697 \def\kbd#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{kbd
}\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??
\par}}
2699 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
2700 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
2701 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
2702 \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
2704 \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
2705 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
2706 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
2707 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2708 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
2709 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2711 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
2712 \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle setting `
\txiarg'
}%
2715 \def\worddistinct{distinct
}
2716 \def\wordexample{example
}
2719 % Default is `distinct'.
2720 \kbdinputstyle distinct
2723 \def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??
}%
2724 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
2725 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd
}\look}}\fi
2726 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd
}\look}}\fi}
2728 % For @indicateurl, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code.
2729 \let\indicateurl=
\code
2733 % @clicksequence{File @click{} Open ...}
2734 \def\clicksequence#1{\begingroup #1\endgroup}
2736 % @clickstyle @arrow (by default)
2737 \parseargdef\clickstyle{\def\click{#1}}
2740 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
2741 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
2743 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
2745 % @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'',
2746 % and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for
2747 % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96.
2748 %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null}
2750 % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
2751 % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
2754 \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,
\finish}
2755 \def\doacronym#1,
#2,
#3\finish{%
2756 {\selectfonts\lsize #1}%
2758 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2759 \space (
{\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})
%
2761 \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
2764 % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
2765 % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
2767 \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,
\finish}
2768 \def\doabbr#1,
#2,
#3\finish{%
2769 {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2771 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2772 \space (
{\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})
%
2774 \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
2777 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
2781 % @math outputs its argument in math mode.
2783 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
2784 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
2785 % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
2786 % which is what @var uses.
2788 \catcode`
\_ =
\active
2789 \gdef\mathunderscore{%
2791 \def_{\ifnum\fam=
\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
2794 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a math (or tt) \.
2795 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (for no
2796 % particular reason), but this is not advertised and we don't care.
2798 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
2799 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=
\ttfam \mathchar"
075C
\else\backslash \fi}
2804 \let\\ =
\mathbackslash
2806 % make the texinfo accent commands work in math mode
2818 \def\finishmath#1{#1$
\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
2820 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
2821 % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
2822 % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
2825 \catcode`^ =
\active
2826 \catcode`< =
\active
2827 \catcode`> =
\active
2828 \catcode`+ =
\active
2829 \catcode`' =
\active
2835 \let' =
\ptexquoteright
2839 % @inlinefmt{FMTNAME,PROCESSED-TEXT} and @inlineraw{FMTNAME,RAW-TEXT}.
2840 % Ignore unless FMTNAME == tex; then it is like @iftex and @tex,
2841 % except specified as a normal braced arg, so no newlines to worry about.
2843 \def\outfmtnametex{tex
}
2845 \long\def\inlinefmt#1{\doinlinefmt #1,
\finish}
2846 \long\def\doinlinefmt#1,
#2,
\finish{%
2847 \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
2848 \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
2850 % For raw, must switch into @tex before parsing the argument, to avoid
2851 % setting catcodes prematurely. Doing it this way means that, for
2852 % example, @inlineraw{html, foo{bar} gets a parse error instead of being
2853 % ignored. But this isn't important because if people want a literal
2854 % *right* brace they would have to use a command anyway, so they may as
2855 % well use a command to get a left brace too. We could re-use the
2856 % delimiter character idea from \verb, but it seems like overkill.
2858 \long\def\inlineraw{\tex \doinlineraw}
2859 \long\def\doinlineraw#1{\doinlinerawtwo #1,
\finish}
2860 \def\doinlinerawtwo#1,
#2,
\finish{%
2861 \def\inlinerawname{#1}%
2862 \ifx\inlinerawname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
2863 \endgroup % close group opened by \tex.
2870 % @@ prints an @, as does @atchar{}.
2874 % @{ @} @lbracechar{} @rbracechar{} all generate brace characters.
2875 % Unless we're in typewriter, use \ecfont because the CM text fonts do
2876 % not have braces, and we don't want to switch into math.
2877 \def\mylbrace{{\ifmonospace\else\ecfont\fi \char123}}
2878 \def\myrbrace{{\ifmonospace\else\ecfont\fi \char125}}
2879 \let\
{=
\mylbrace \let\lbracechar=\
{
2880 \let\
}=
\myrbrace \let\rbracechar=\
}
2882 % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
2883 % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files.
2884 \catcode`\
{ =
\other \catcode`\
} =
\other
2885 \catcode`\
[ =
1 \catcode`\
] =
2
2886 \catcode`\! =
0 \catcode`\\ =
\other
2887 !gdef!lbracecmd
[\
{]%
2888 !gdef!rbracecmd
[\
}]%
2889 !gdef!lbraceatcmd
[@
{]%
2890 !gdef!rbraceatcmd
[@
}]%
2893 % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
2896 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
2897 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
2899 \let\dotaccent =
\ptexdot
2900 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
2901 \let\tieaccent =
\ptext
2902 \let\ubaraccent =
\ptexb
2903 \let\udotaccent =
\d
2905 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
2906 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
2907 \def\questiondown{?`
}
2909 \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a
}}}
2910 \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o
}}}
2912 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
2917 \ifx\temp\imacro \ifmmode\imath \else\ptexi \fi
2918 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \ifmmode\jmath \else\j \fi
2919 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j
}%
2923 % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
2924 % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
2926 \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=
1000 }
2928 % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
2929 % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
2930 % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
2931 % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
2932 % \scriptscriptstyle).
2937 \vbox to
\ht0{\hbox{%
2938 \ifx\textnominalsize\xwordpt
2939 % for 10pt running text, \lllsize (8pt) is too small for the A in LaTeX.
2940 % Revert to plain's \scriptsize, which is 7pt.
2941 \count255=
\the\fam $
\fam\count255 \scriptstyle A$
%
2943 % For 11pt, we can use our lllsize.
2944 \selectfonts\lllsize A
%
2953 % Some math mode symbols.
2954 \def\bullet{$
\ptexbullet$
}
2955 \def\geq{\ifmmode \ge\else $
\ge$
\fi}
2956 \def\leq{\ifmmode \le\else $
\le$
\fi}
2957 \def\minus{\ifmmode -
\else $-$
\fi}
2959 % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
2960 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
2961 % typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
2962 % in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
2963 % whichever is larger.
2967 \setbox0=
\hbox{...
}% get width of three periods
2974 \hskip 0pt plus
.25fil
2975 .
\hskip 0pt plus1fil
2976 .
\hskip 0pt plus1fil
2977 .
\hskip 0pt plus
.5fil
2981 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
2985 \spacefactor=
\endofsentencespacefactor
2988 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
2990 % Since these characters are used in examples, they should be an even number of
2991 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
2994 \def\arrow{\leavevmode\raise.05ex
\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\rightarrow$
\hfil}}
2995 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.05ex
\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\Rightarrow$
\hfil}}
2996 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\mapsto$
\hfil}}
2997 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex
\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\dashv$
\hfil}}
2998 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\hbox to
1em
{\hfil$
\ptexequiv$
\hfil}}
3000 % The @error{} command.
3001 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
3005 {\tentt \global\dimen0 =
3em
}% Width of the box.
3006 \dimen2 =
.55pt
% Thickness of rules
3007 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
3008 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\kern-
.75pt
\reducedsf \putworderror\kern-
1.5pt
}
3010 \setbox\errorbox=
\hbox to
\dimen0{\hfil
3011 \hsize =
\dimen0 \advance\hsize by -
5.8pt
% Space to left+right.
3012 \advance\hsize by -
2\dimen2 % Rules.
3014 \hrule height
\dimen2
3015 \hbox{\vrule width
\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
3016 \vtop{\kern2.4pt
\box0 \kern2.4pt
}% Space above/below.
3017 \kern3pt\vrule width
\dimen2}% Space to right.
3018 \hrule height
\dimen2}
3021 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex
\copy\errorbox}
3023 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
3025 \def\pounds{{\it\$
}}
3027 % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
3028 % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
3029 % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
3030 % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
3031 % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
3033 % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
3034 % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
3040 % feybo - bold slanted
3042 % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
3043 % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
3046 % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
3050 \def\euro{{\eurofont e
}}
3052 % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
3053 % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
3054 % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
3057 % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
3058 % that to the current nominal size.
3060 % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
3061 % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
3063 \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize
\endcsname}%
3065 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
3067 \font\thiseurofont =
\ifusingit{feybo10
}{feybr10
} at
\eurosize
3070 \font\thiseurofont =
\ifusingit{feymo10
}{feymr10
} at
\eurosize
3075 % Glyphs from the EC fonts. We don't use \let for the aliases, because
3076 % sometimes we redefine the original macro, and the alias should reflect
3079 % Use LaTeX names for the Icelandic letters.
3080 \def\DH{{\ecfont \char"D0
}} % Eth
3081 \def\dh{{\ecfont \char"F0
}} % eth
3082 \def\TH{{\ecfont \char"DE
}} % Thorn
3083 \def\th{{\ecfont \char"FE
}} % thorn
3085 \def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"
13}}
3086 \def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft}
3087 \def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"
14}}
3088 \def\guillemotright{\guillemetright}
3089 \def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"
0E
}}
3090 \def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"
0F
}}
3091 \def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"
12}}
3092 \def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"
0D
}}
3094 % This positioning is not perfect (see the ogonek LaTeX package), but
3095 % we have the precomposed glyphs for the most common cases. We put the
3096 % tests to use those glyphs in the single \ogonek macro so we have fewer
3097 % dummy definitions to worry about for index entries, etc.
3099 % ogonek is also used with other letters in Lithuanian (IOU), but using
3100 % the precomposed glyphs for those is not so easy since they aren't in
3104 \ifx\temp\macrocharA\Aogonek
3105 \else\ifx\temp\macrochara\aogonek
3106 \else\ifx\temp\macrocharE\Eogonek
3107 \else\ifx\temp\macrochare\eogonek
3109 \ecfont \setbox0=
\hbox{#1}%
3110 \ifdim\ht0=
1ex
\accent"
0C
#1%
3111 \else\ooalign{\unhbox0\crcr\hidewidth\char"
0C
\hidewidth}%
3116 \def\Aogonek{{\ecfont \char"
81}}\def\macrocharA{A
}
3117 \def\aogonek{{\ecfont \char"A1
}}\def\macrochara{a
}
3118 \def\Eogonek{{\ecfont \char"
86}}\def\macrocharE{E
}
3119 \def\eogonek{{\ecfont \char"A6
}}\def\macrochare{e
}
3121 % Use the ec* fonts (cm-super in outline format) for non-CM glyphs.
3123 % We can't distinguish serif/sans and italic/slanted, but this
3124 % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German
3125 % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so
3126 % hopefully nobody will notice/care.
3127 \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize
\endcsname}%
3128 \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize
\endcsname}%
3129 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
3131 \font\thisecfont = ecb
\ifusingit{i
}{x
}\ecsize \space at
\nominalsize
3134 \font\thisecfont = ec
\ifusingit{ti
}{rm
}\ecsize \space at
\nominalsize
3139 % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
3140 % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
3141 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
3143 \def\registeredsymbol{%
3144 $^
{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex
\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R
}%
3149 % @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
3151 \def\textdegree{$^
\circ$
}
3153 % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
3154 % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
3155 % so we'll define it if necessary.
3157 \ifx\Orb\thisisundefined
3158 \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
3162 \chardef\quotedblleft="
5C
3163 \chardef\quotedblright=`\"
3164 \chardef\quoteleft=`\`
3165 \chardef\quoteright=`\'
3168 \message{page headings,
}
3170 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue =
1.5in
3171 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue =
2pc
3173 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
3175 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage
3177 % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the
3178 % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage.
3180 \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
3181 \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage =
\setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
3182 \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
3183 \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage =
\setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
3185 \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{%
3186 \begingroup \hbox{}\vskip 1.5in
\chaprm \centerline{#1}%
3187 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
3190 % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
3192 \parindent=
0pt
\textfonts
3193 % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
3194 \vglue\titlepagetopglue
3195 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
3196 \finishedtitlepagetrue
3198 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
3199 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
3200 \let\oldpage =
\page
3202 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
3205 \let\page =
\oldpage
3212 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
3215 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
3216 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
3217 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
3218 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
3222 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
3223 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
3226 % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
3227 \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
3230 \global\let\shortcontents =
\relax
3231 \global\let\contents =
\relax
3234 \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
3236 \global\let\contents =
\relax
3237 \global\let\shortcontents =
\relax
3241 \def\finishtitlepage{%
3242 \vskip4pt \hrule height
2pt width
\hsize
3243 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
3244 \finishedtitlepagetrue
3247 % Macros to be used within @titlepage:
3249 \let\subtitlerm=
\tenrm
3250 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip =
13pt
\normalbaselines}
3252 \parseargdef\title{%
3254 \leftline{\titlefonts\rmisbold #1}
3255 % print a rule at the page bottom also.
3256 \finishedtitlepagefalse
3257 \vskip4pt \hrule height
4pt width
\hsize \vskip4pt
3260 \parseargdef\subtitle{%
3262 {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
3265 % @author should come last, but may come many times.
3266 % It can also be used inside @quotation.
3268 \parseargdef\author{%
3269 \def\temp{\quotation}%
3271 \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
3274 \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus
1filll
\seenauthortrue \fi
3275 {\secfonts\rmisbold \leftline{#1}}%
3280 % Set up page headings and footings.
3282 \let\thispage=
\folio
3284 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
3285 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
3286 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
3287 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
3289 % Now make TeX use those variables
3290 \headline=
{{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
3291 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
3292 \footline=
{{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
3293 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
3294 \let\HEADINGShook=
\relax
3296 % Commands to set those variables.
3297 % For example, this is what @headings on does
3298 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
3299 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
3300 % @evenfooting @thisfile||
3301 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile
3304 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
3305 \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|
\finish}
3306 \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|
#2\|
#3\|
#4\finish{%
3307 \global\evenheadline=
{\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3309 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
3310 \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|
\finish}
3311 \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|
#2\|
#3\|
#4\finish{%
3312 \global\oddheadline=
{\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3314 \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
3316 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
3317 \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|
\finish}
3318 \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|
#2\|
#3\|
#4\finish{%
3319 \global\evenfootline=
{\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3321 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
3322 \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|
\finish}
3323 \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|
#2\|
#3\|
#4\finish{%
3324 \global\oddfootline =
{\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
3326 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
3327 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
3328 \global\advance\pageheight by -
12pt
3329 \global\advance\vsize by -
12pt
3332 \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
3334 % @evenheadingmarks top \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page
3335 % @evenheadingmarks bottom \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page
3337 % The same set of arguments for:
3342 % @everyheadingmarks
3343 % @everyfootingmarks
3345 \def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even
}{heading
}}
3346 \def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd
}{heading
}}
3347 \def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even
}{footing
}}
3348 \def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd
}{footing
}}
3349 \def\everyheadingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even
}{heading
}{#1}
3350 \headingmarks{odd
}{heading
}{#1} }
3351 \def\everyfootingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even
}{footing
}{#1}
3352 \headingmarks{odd
}{footing
}{#1} }
3353 % #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom.
3354 \def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {%
3355 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get
#3headingmarks
\endcsname
3356 \global\expandafter\let\csname get
#1#2marks
\endcsname \temp
3359 \everyheadingmarks bottom
3360 \everyfootingmarks bottom
3362 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
3363 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
3364 % @headings off turns them off.
3365 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
3366 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
3367 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
3368 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
3369 % By default, they are off at the start of a document,
3370 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
3372 \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS
#1\endcsname}
3374 \def\headingsoff{% non-global headings elimination
3375 \evenheadline=
{\hfil}\evenfootline=
{\hfil}%
3376 \oddheadline=
{\hfil}\oddfootline=
{\hfil}%
3379 \def\HEADINGSoff{{\globaldefs=
1 \headingsoff}} % global setting
3380 \HEADINGSoff % it's the default
3382 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
3383 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
3384 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
3385 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
3386 % edge of all pages.
3387 \def\HEADINGSdouble{%
3389 \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
3390 \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}
3391 \global\evenheadline=
{\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3392 \global\oddheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3393 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chapoddpage
3395 \let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
3397 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
3398 % page number on top right.
3399 \def\HEADINGSsingle{%
3401 \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
3402 \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}
3403 \global\evenheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3404 \global\oddheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3405 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
3407 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
3409 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=
\HEADINGSdoublex}
3410 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=
\HEADINGSafter
3411 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
3412 \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
3413 \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}
3414 \global\evenheadline=
{\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3415 \global\oddheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3416 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chapoddpage
3419 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=
\HEADINGSsinglex}
3420 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
3421 \global\evenfootline=
{\hfil}
3422 \global\oddfootline=
{\hfil}
3423 \global\evenheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3424 \global\oddheadline=
{\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3425 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
3428 % Subroutines used in generating headings
3429 % This produces Day Month Year style of output.
3430 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
3431 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
3432 \ifx\today\thisisundefined
3436 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
3437 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
3438 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
3443 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
3444 % It generates no output of its own.
3445 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
3446 \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
3450 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
3452 % default indentation of table text
3453 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=
.8in
3454 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
3455 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=
.3in
3456 % margin between end of table item and start of table text.
3457 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=
.1in
3459 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
3462 % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
3464 % They also define \itemindex
3465 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
3467 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
3469 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-
\parskip\nobreak\fi}
3471 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
3472 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
3474 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
3475 \advance\hsize by -
\rightskip
3476 \advance\hsize by -
\tableindent
3477 \setbox0=
\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
3479 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
3481 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
3482 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
3483 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
3484 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
3485 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
3486 \ifdim \wd0>
\itemmax
3488 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
3489 % but leave it ragged-right.
3491 \advance\leftskip by-
\tableindent
3492 \advance\hsize by
\tableindent
3493 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil
\relax
3494 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
3497 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
3498 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
3499 \nobreak \vskip-
\parskip
3501 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
3502 % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
3503 % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
3504 % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
3505 % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
3506 % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
3510 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
3512 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
3513 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
3515 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
3516 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
3517 % eventually be printed.
3518 \nobreak\kern-
\tableindent
3519 \dimen0 =
\itemmax \advance\dimen0 by
\itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -
\wd0
3521 \nobreak\kern\dimen0
3523 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
3527 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment
}}
3528 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment
}}
3530 % @table, @ftable, @vtable.
3532 \let\itemindex\gobble
3536 \def\itemindex #
#1{\doind {fn
}{\code{#
#1}}}%
3537 \tablecheck{ftable
}%
3540 \def\itemindex #
#1{\doind {vr
}{\code{#
#1}}}%
3541 \tablecheck{vtable
}%
3544 \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=
\active
3546 \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
3547 that we are
\inenvironment\thisenv}%
3548 \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
3555 \def\itemindicate{#1}%
3560 \makevalueexpandable
3561 \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
3565 \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
3567 \ifnum 0#1>
0 \advance \leftskip by
#1\mil \fi
3568 \ifnum 0#2>
0 \tableindent=
#2\mil \fi
3569 \ifnum 0#3>
0 \advance \rightskip by
#3\mil \fi
3570 \itemmax=
\tableindent
3571 \advance \itemmax by -
\itemmargin
3572 \advance \leftskip by
\tableindent
3573 \exdentamount=
\tableindent
3575 \parskip =
\smallskipamount
3576 \ifdim \parskip=
0pt
\parskip=
2pt
\fi
3577 \let\item =
\internalBitem
3578 \let\itemx =
\internalBitemx
3580 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
3583 \let\Eitemize\Etable
3584 \let\Eenumerate\Etable
3586 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
3590 \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
3594 \itemmax=
\itemindent
3595 \advance\itemmax by -
\itemmargin
3596 \advance\leftskip by
\itemindent
3597 \exdentamount=
\itemindent
3599 \parskip=
\smallskipamount
3600 \ifdim\parskip=
0pt
\parskip=
2pt
\fi
3602 % Try typesetting the item mark that if the document erroneously says
3603 % something like @itemize @samp (intending @table), there's an error
3604 % right away at the @itemize. It's not the best error message in the
3605 % world, but it's better than leaving it to the @item. This means if
3606 % the user wants an empty mark, they have to say @w{} not just @w.
3607 \def\itemcontents{#1}%
3608 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\itemcontents}%
3610 % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
3611 \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
3613 \let\item=
\itemizeitem
3616 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
3619 \advance\itemno by
1 % for enumerations
3620 {\let\par=
\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
3622 % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
3623 % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
3624 % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
3625 % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
3626 % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
3627 % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
3628 % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
3629 % that's the theory.
3630 \ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000 \parskip=
0in
\fi
3632 \hbox to
0pt
{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
3634 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item.
3638 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
3639 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
3641 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
3643 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
3644 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
3645 % argument is the same as `1'.
3647 \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
3648 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
3649 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
3651 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
3653 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
3654 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
3655 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
3656 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
3657 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
3658 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
3660 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
3661 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
3662 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
3663 % not equal to itself.
3664 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
3666 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
3667 % continuing to look for a <number>.
3669 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`
\thearg=
0\relax
3670 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
3673 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`
\thearg=
\expandafter`
\thearg\relax
3674 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
3676 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
3680 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
3685 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
3688 \def\numericenumerate{%
3690 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
3693 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
3694 \def\lowercaseenumerate{%
3695 \itemno =
\expandafter`
\thearg
3697 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3699 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3706 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
3707 \def\uppercaseenumerate{%
3708 \itemno =
\expandafter`
\thearg
3710 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3712 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3719 % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
3720 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
3721 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
3723 \def\startenumeration#1{%
3724 \advance\itemno by -
1
3725 \doitemize{#1.
}\flushcr
3728 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
3731 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a
}}
3732 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A
}}
3733 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3734 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3737 % @multitable macros
3738 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
3740 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
3741 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
3742 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
3743 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
3745 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
3749 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
3750 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
3753 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
3754 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
3755 % columns as desired.
3758 % Or use a template:
3759 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3761 % using the widest term desired in each column.
3763 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
3764 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
3765 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
3766 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
3768 % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
3771 % Sample multitable:
3773 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3774 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
3781 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
3782 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
3784 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
3785 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
3788 % Default dimensions may be reset by user.
3789 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
3790 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
3791 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
3792 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
3794 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
3796 \newskip\multitableparskip
3797 \newskip\multitableparindent
3798 \newdimen\multitablecolspace
3799 \newskip\multitablelinespace
3800 \multitableparskip=
0pt
3801 \multitableparindent=
6pt
3802 \multitablecolspace=
12pt
3803 \multitablelinespace=
0pt
3805 % Macros used to set up halign preamble:
3807 \let\endsetuptable\relax
3808 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
3809 \let\columnfractions\relax
3810 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
3813 % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
3814 % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
3816 \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
3817 \global\advance\colcount by
1
3818 \expandafter\xdef\csname col
\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
3825 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
3828 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
3829 \global\setpercenttrue
3832 \let\go\pickupwholefraction
3834 \global\advance\colcount by
1
3835 \setbox0=
\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
3836 % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
3837 \expandafter\xdef\csname col
\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
3840 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
3841 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
3842 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
3843 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
3845 \let\go =
\setuptable
3851 % multitable-only commands.
3853 % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold.
3854 % Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group
3855 % of an alignment entry. \everycr resets \everytab so we don't have to
3856 % undo it ourselves.
3857 \def\headitemfont{\b}% for people to use in the template row; not changeable
3859 \checkenv\multitable
3861 \global\everytab=
{\bf}% can't use \headitemfont since the parsing differs
3862 \the\everytab % for the first item
3865 % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
3866 % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
3867 % we again encounter the problem the 1sp was intended to solve.
3868 % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
3869 \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &
\the\everytab}%
3871 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
3873 \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
3875 \envdef\multitable{%
3879 % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
3880 % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
3881 % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
3882 % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
3887 \setmultitablespacing
3888 \parskip=
\multitableparskip
3889 \parindent=
\multitableparindent
3895 \global\everytab=
{}%
3896 \global\colcount=
0 % Reset the column counter.
3897 % Check for saved footnotes, etc.
3899 % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
3901 % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the
3902 % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the
3903 % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl.
3907 \parsearg\domultitable
3909 \def\domultitable#1{%
3910 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
3911 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
3913 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
3914 % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
3915 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
3916 % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
3918 \global\advance\colcount by
1
3921 % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
3922 \hsize=
\expandafter\csname col
\the\colcount\endcsname
3924 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
3925 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
3928 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
3929 % to the width of each template entry.
3931 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
3932 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
3933 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
3934 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
3936 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
3939 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
3940 \advance\hsize by
\leftskip
3943 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
3944 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
3945 \advance\hsize by
\multitablecolspace
3947 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
3948 \leftskip=
\multitablecolspace
3950 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
3951 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
3952 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
3954 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
3956 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
3957 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
3958 % marking characters.
3959 \noindent\ignorespaces##
\unskip\multistrut
3964 \egroup % end the \halign
3965 \global\setpercentfalse
3968 \def\setmultitablespacing{%
3969 \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
3971 % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
3972 % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
3973 % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
3974 % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
3975 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=
0pt
3976 \setbox0=
\vbox{X
}\global\multitablelinespace=
\the\baselineskip
3977 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-
\ht0
3979 % Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
3980 % table. If not, do nothing.
3981 % If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
3982 \ifdim\multitableparskip>
\multitablelinespace
3983 \global\multitableparskip=
\multitablelinespace
3984 \global\advance\multitableparskip-
7pt
% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
3985 % than skip between lines in the table.
3987 \ifdim\multitableparskip=
0pt
3988 \global\multitableparskip=
\multitablelinespace
3989 \global\advance\multitableparskip-
7pt
% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
3990 % than skip between lines in the table.
3994 \message{conditionals,
}
3996 % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
3997 % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
3998 % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
3999 % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
4000 % attempt to close an environment group.
4003 \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname =
\relax
4004 \expandafter\let\csname iscond.
#1\endcsname =
1
4007 \makecond{ifnotdocbook
}
4008 \makecond{ifnothtml
}
4009 \makecond{ifnotinfo
}
4010 \makecond{ifnotplaintext
}
4013 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
4015 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry
}}
4016 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription
}}
4017 \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook
}}
4018 \def\html{\doignore{html
}}
4019 \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook
}}
4020 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml
}}
4021 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo
}}
4022 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex
}}
4023 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext
}}
4024 \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml
}}
4025 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore
}}
4026 \def\menu{\doignore{menu
}}
4027 \def\xml{\doignore{xml
}}
4029 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
4031 % A count to remember the depth of nesting.
4032 \newcount\doignorecount
4034 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup
4035 % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
4037 \catcode`\@ =
\other
4038 \catcode`\
{ =
\other
4039 \catcode`\
} =
\other
4041 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
4044 % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
4047 % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
4051 { \catcode`_=
11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
4054 \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
4055 % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
4057 % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
4058 \long\def\doignoretext#
#1^^M@end
#1{%
4059 \doignoretextyyy#
#1^^M@
#1\_STOP_}%
4061 % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
4062 % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
4063 % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
4064 \long\def\doignoretextyyy#
#1^^M@
#1#
#2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{#
#2}\_STOP_}%
4066 % And now expand that command.
4071 \def\doignoreyyy#1{%
4073 \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
4074 \let\next\doignoretextzzz
4075 \else % Found a nested condition, ...
4076 \advance\doignorecount by
1
4077 \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
4078 % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
4080 \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
4083 % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
4085 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
4086 \ifnum\doignorecount =
0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
4087 \let\next\enddoignore
4088 \else % Still inside a nested condition.
4089 \advance\doignorecount by -
1
4090 \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
4095 % Finish off ignored text.
4097 % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
4098 % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
4099 % would result in a blank line in the output.
4100 \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M
{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
4104 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
4105 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
4107 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
4108 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
4109 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
4111 % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
4113 \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
4114 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
4116 \makevalueexpandable
4118 \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET
#1}}%
4126 % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
4127 \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
4129 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
4131 \parseargdef\clear{%
4133 \makevalueexpandable
4134 \global\expandafter\let\csname SET
#1\endcsname=
\relax
4138 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
4139 \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
4140 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
4142 \catcode`\- =
\active \catcode`
\_ =
\active
4144 \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
4145 \let\value =
\expandablevalue
4146 % We don't want these characters active, ...
4147 \catcode`\-=
\other \catcode`
\_=
\other
4148 % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
4149 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
4150 % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
4151 \let-
\realdash \let_\normalunderscore
4155 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
4156 % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
4157 % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
4158 % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
4159 % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
4160 % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
4161 % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
4163 \def\expandablevalue#1{%
4164 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET
#1\endcsname\relax
4165 {[No value for ``
#1''
]}%
4166 \message{Variable `
#1', used in @value, is not set.
}%
4168 \csname SET
#1\endcsname
4172 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
4175 % To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine.
4178 \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=
\ifsetfail}}}
4181 \makevalueexpandable
4183 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET
#2\endcsname\relax
4184 #1% If not set, redefine \next.
4189 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset
}}
4191 % @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been
4192 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
4194 % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
4195 % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
4196 % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
4199 \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=
\ifclearfail}}}
4200 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear
}}
4202 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
4203 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
4204 \let\dircategory=
\comment
4206 % @defininfoenclose.
4207 \let\definfoenclose=
\comment
4211 % Index generation facilities
4213 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
4214 % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
4215 \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite
}}
4217 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo.
4218 % It automatically defines \fooindex such that
4219 % \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo.
4220 % It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for
4221 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo.
4222 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
4223 % for the sake of vms.
4227 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile
\endcsname
4228 \openout \csname#1indfile
\endcsname \jobname.
#1 % Open the file
4230 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index
\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
4231 \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
4234 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
4236 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
4238 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
4240 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
4242 \def\newcodeindex#1{%
4244 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile
\endcsname
4245 \openout \csname#1indfile
\endcsname \jobname.
#1
4247 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index
\endcsname{%
4248 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
4252 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
4253 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
4255 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
4258 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
4259 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
4261 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
4262 % #3 the target index (bar).
4263 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
4264 % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up
4265 % closing the target index.
4266 \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex
#2\endcsname \relax
4267 % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the
4268 % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files.
4269 \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile
\endcsname
4270 \expandafter\let\csname donesynindex
#2\endcsname =
1
4272 % redefine \fooindfile:
4273 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=
\csname#3indfile
\endcsname
4274 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile
\endcsname=
\temp
4275 % redefine \fooindex:
4276 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index
\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
4279 % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros.
4280 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
4281 % and it is "foo", the name of the index.
4283 % \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work.
4284 % This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros.
4286 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
4287 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
4289 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer}
4290 \def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
4292 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
4293 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer}
4294 \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
4296 % Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
4297 % Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't,
4298 % we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't.
4301 \escapechar = `\\
% use backslash in output files.
4302 \def\@
{@
}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files.
4303 \def\
{\realbackslash\space }%
4305 % Need these unexpandable (because we define \tt as a dummy)
4306 % definitions when @{ or @} appear in index entry text. Also, more
4307 % complicated, when \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
4308 % We can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
4309 % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters. Perhaps we
4310 % should define @lbrace and @rbrace commands a la @comma.
4311 \def\
{{{\tt\char123}}%
4312 \def\
}{{\tt\char125}}%
4314 % I don't entirely understand this, but when an index entry is
4315 % generated from a macro call, the \endinput which \scanmacro inserts
4316 % causes processing to be prematurely terminated. This is,
4317 % apparently, because \indexsorttmp is fully expanded, and \endinput
4318 % is an expandable command. The redefinition below makes \endinput
4319 % disappear altogether for that purpose -- although logging shows that
4320 % processing continues to some further point. On the other hand, it
4321 % seems \endinput does not hurt in the printed index arg, since that
4322 % is still getting written without apparent harm.
4324 % Sample source (mac-idx3.tex, reported by Graham Percival to
4325 % help-texinfo, 22may06):
4326 % @macro funindex {WORD}
4330 % @funindex commtest
4332 % The above is not enough to reproduce the bug, but it gives the flavor.
4334 % Sample whatsit resulting:
4335 % .@write3{\entry{xyz}{@folio }{@code {xyz@endinput }}}
4338 \let\endinput =
\empty
4340 % Do the redefinitions.
4344 % For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character. So we want to
4345 % redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of
4346 % \realbackslash, still used for index files). When everything uses @,
4347 % this will be simpler.
4352 \let\
{ =
\lbraceatcmd
4353 \let\
} =
\rbraceatcmd
4355 % Do the redefinitions.
4360 % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies.
4362 \def\commondummies{%
4364 % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
4365 % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control words,
4366 % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
4367 % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
4368 % from whatever follows.
4370 % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
4373 % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
4374 % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
4375 % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
4377 \def\definedummyword #
#1{\def#
#1{\string#
#1\space}}%
4378 \def\definedummyletter#
#1{\def#
#1{\string#
#1}}%
4379 \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
4381 \commondummiesnofonts
4383 \definedummyletter\_%
4384 \definedummyletter\-
%
4386 % Non-English letters.
4397 \definedummyword\exclamdown
4401 \definedummyword\ordf
4402 \definedummyword\ordm
4403 \definedummyword\questiondown
4407 % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
4409 \definedummyword\gtr
4410 \definedummyword\hat
4411 \definedummyword\less
4414 \definedummyword\tclose
4417 \definedummyword\LaTeX
4418 \definedummyword\TeX
4420 % Assorted special characters.
4421 \definedummyword\arrow
4422 \definedummyword\bullet
4423 \definedummyword\comma
4424 \definedummyword\copyright
4425 \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
4426 \definedummyword\dots
4427 \definedummyword\enddots
4428 \definedummyword\entrybreak
4429 \definedummyword\equiv
4430 \definedummyword\error
4431 \definedummyword\euro
4432 \definedummyword\expansion
4433 \definedummyword\geq
4434 \definedummyword\guillemetleft
4435 \definedummyword\guillemetright
4436 \definedummyword\guilsinglleft
4437 \definedummyword\guilsinglright
4438 \definedummyword\leq
4439 \definedummyword\minus
4440 \definedummyword\ogonek
4441 \definedummyword\pounds
4442 \definedummyword\point
4443 \definedummyword\print
4444 \definedummyword\quotedblbase
4445 \definedummyword\quotedblleft
4446 \definedummyword\quotedblright
4447 \definedummyword\quoteleft
4448 \definedummyword\quoteright
4449 \definedummyword\quotesinglbase
4450 \definedummyword\result
4451 \definedummyword\textdegree
4453 % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
4456 \normalturnoffactive
4458 % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any
4459 % (non-fully-expandable) commands.
4460 \makevalueexpandable
4463 % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts.
4465 \def\commondummiesnofonts{%
4466 % Control letters and accents.
4467 \definedummyletter\!
%
4468 \definedummyaccent\"
%
4469 \definedummyaccent\'
%
4470 \definedummyletter\*
%
4471 \definedummyaccent\,
%
4472 \definedummyletter\.
%
4473 \definedummyletter\/
%
4474 \definedummyletter\:
%
4475 \definedummyaccent\=
%
4476 \definedummyletter\?
%
4477 \definedummyaccent\^
%
4478 \definedummyaccent\`
%
4479 \definedummyaccent\~
%
4483 \definedummyword\dotaccent
4484 \definedummyword\ogonek
4485 \definedummyword\ringaccent
4486 \definedummyword\tieaccent
4487 \definedummyword\ubaraccent
4488 \definedummyword\udotaccent
4489 \definedummyword\dotless
4491 % Texinfo font commands.
4495 \definedummyword\sansserif
4497 \definedummyword\slanted
4500 % Commands that take arguments.
4501 \definedummyword\acronym
4502 \definedummyword\anchor
4503 \definedummyword\cite
4504 \definedummyword\code
4505 \definedummyword\command
4506 \definedummyword\dfn
4507 \definedummyword\dmn
4508 \definedummyword\email
4509 \definedummyword\emph
4510 \definedummyword\env
4511 \definedummyword\file
4512 \definedummyword\indicateurl
4513 \definedummyword\kbd
4514 \definedummyword\key
4515 \definedummyword\math
4516 \definedummyword\option
4517 \definedummyword\pxref
4518 \definedummyword\ref
4519 \definedummyword\samp
4520 \definedummyword\strong
4521 \definedummyword\tie
4522 \definedummyword\uref
4523 \definedummyword\url
4524 \definedummyword\var
4525 \definedummyword\verb
4527 \definedummyword\xref
4530 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
4531 % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
4532 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
4533 % would be for a given command (usually its argument).
4536 % Accent commands should become @asis.
4537 \def\definedummyaccent#
#1{\let#
#1\asis}%
4538 % We can just ignore other control letters.
4539 \def\definedummyletter#
#1{\let#
#1\empty}%
4540 % All control words become @asis by default; overrides below.
4541 \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent
4543 \commondummiesnofonts
4545 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
4546 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
4547 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
4552 \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
4553 \def\-
{}% @- shouldn't affect sorting
4555 % Unfortunately, texindex is not prepared to handle braces in the
4556 % content at all. So for index sorting, we map @{ and @} to strings
4557 % starting with |, since that ASCII character is between ASCII { and }.
4561 % Non-English letters.
4578 \def\questiondown{?
}%
4585 % Assorted special characters.
4586 % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.)
4588 \def\bullet{bullet
}%
4590 \def\copyright{copyright
}%
4596 \def\expansion{==>
}%
4598 \def\guillemetleft{<<
}%
4599 \def\guillemetright{>>
}%
4600 \def\guilsinglleft{<
}%
4601 \def\guilsinglright{>
}%
4605 \def\pounds{pounds
}%
4607 \def\quotedblbase{"
}%
4608 \def\quotedblleft{"
}%
4609 \def\quotedblright{"
}%
4612 \def\quotesinglbase{,
}%
4613 \def\registeredsymbol{R
}%
4617 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlquoteignore
\endcsname\relax
4618 \else \indexlquoteignore \fi
4620 % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
4621 % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
4622 % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
4623 % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
4624 % that starts with \.
4626 % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
4627 % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
4628 % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
4633 % Undocumented (for FSFS 2nd ed.): @set txiindexlquoteignore makes us
4634 % ignore left quotes in the sort term.
4635 {\catcode`\`=
\active
4636 \gdef\indexlquoteignore{\let`=
\empty}}
4638 \let\indexbackslash=
0 %overridden during \printindex.
4639 \let\SETmarginindex=
\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
4641 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
4642 % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
4643 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
4645 % Workhorse for all \fooindexes.
4646 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
4647 % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
4648 % is with most defuns, which call us directly).
4650 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
4653 % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
4655 % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
4657 \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
4658 \toks0 =
\expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
4661 \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile
\endcsname}%
4663 \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite
4668 % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file:
4670 \def\dosubindwrite{%
4671 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
4672 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
4673 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt
\the\toks0}}%
4676 % Remember, we are within a group.
4677 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
4678 \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
4679 % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash.
4681 % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to
4682 % get the string to sort by.
4684 \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion
4685 \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}%
4688 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
4689 % the original text, including any font commands. We write
4690 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
4691 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
4695 \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
4700 % Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
4702 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
4703 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
4704 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
4705 % \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that
4706 % sequences like this:
4710 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
4711 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
4712 % the previous defun.
4714 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
4715 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
4717 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
4719 % But wait, there is a catch there:
4720 % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
4721 % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
4722 % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
4723 % representation of the skip.
4725 % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
4726 % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
4728 \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip
\endcsname}
4730 \newskip\whatsitskip
4731 \newcount\whatsitpenalty
4735 \def\safewhatsit#1{%
4739 % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
4740 \whatsitskip =
\lastskip
4741 \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
4742 \whatsitpenalty =
\lastpenalty
4744 % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
4745 % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
4746 % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a
4747 % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
4748 % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
4749 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
4756 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
4757 % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
4758 % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
4759 % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
4760 % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
4761 % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
4763 % @deffn deffn-whatever
4764 % @vindex index-whatever
4766 % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
4767 % and the "Description." paragraph.
4768 \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>
9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
4770 % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
4771 % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
4772 % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
4773 \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
4778 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like
4779 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
4781 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
4782 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
4783 % containing these kinds of lines:
4785 % before the first topic whose initial is c
4786 % \entry {topic}{pagelist}
4787 % for a topic that is used without subtopics
4789 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
4790 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
4791 % for each subtopic.
4793 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands
4794 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
4796 \def\findex {\fnindex}
4797 \def\kindex {\kyindex}
4798 \def\cindex {\cpindex}
4799 \def\vindex {\vrindex}
4800 \def\tindex {\tpindex}
4801 \def\pindex {\pgindex}
4803 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
4805 \gdef\cindexsub "
#1"
#2^^M
{\endgroup %
4806 \dosubind{cp
}{#2}{#1}}}
4808 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
4810 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
4811 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
4813 \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
4814 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
4819 \everypar =
{}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
4821 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
4822 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
4824 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
4825 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
4827 \openin 1 \jobname.
#1s
4829 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
4830 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
4831 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
4832 % there is some text.
4833 \putwordIndexNonexistent
4836 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
4837 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
4838 % it can discover if there is anything in it.
4841 \putwordIndexIsEmpty
4843 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
4844 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
4845 % to make right now.
4846 \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}%
4857 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
4858 % Change them to control the appearance of the index.
4861 % Some minor font changes for the special characters.
4862 \let\tentt=
\sectt \let\tt=
\sectt \let\sf=
\sectt
4864 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
4867 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
4869 \vskip 0pt plus
3\baselineskip
4871 \vskip 0pt plus -
3\baselineskip
4873 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
4874 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
4875 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
4876 % we need before each entry, but it's better.
4878 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
4879 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus
.5\baselineskip
4880 \leftline{\secbf #1}%
4881 % Do our best not to break after the initial.
4883 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus
.1\baselineskip
4886 % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
4887 % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
4888 % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
4890 % A straightforward implementation would start like this:
4891 % \def\entry#1#2{...
4892 % But this freezes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to
4893 % @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge---
4894 % ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right.
4895 % The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text.
4900 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
4901 % affect previous text.
4904 % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
4907 % No extra space above this paragraph.
4910 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
4911 \finalhyphendemerits =
0
4913 % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
4914 % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the
4915 % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large
4916 % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
4917 % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
4919 % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
4920 % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
4923 % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
4925 \rightskip =
0pt plus1fil
4927 % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing
4931 % When reading the text of entry, convert explicit line breaks
4932 % from @* into spaces. The user might give these in long section
4933 % titles, for instance.
4934 \def\*
{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
4935 \def\entrybreak{\hfil\break}%
4937 % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
4938 \afterassignment\doentry
4941 \def\entrybreak{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
4943 \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
4945 \aftergroup\finishentry
4946 % And now comes the text of the entry.
4948 \def\finishentry#1{%
4949 % #1 is the page number.
4951 % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
4952 % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be
4953 % cursed by a Unix daemon.
4954 \setbox\boxA =
\hbox{#1}%
4955 \ifdim\wd\boxA =
0pt
4959 % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
4960 % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
4961 % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
4963 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
4965 % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
4966 % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull
4979 % Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
4980 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
4981 \hbox{$
\mathsurround=
0pt
\mkern1.5mu.
\mkern1.5mu$
}\hskip 1em plus
1fill
}
4983 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
4985 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=
0.5cm
4986 \def\secondary#1#2{{%
4991 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
4993 \pdfgettoks#2.\
\the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
5000 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
5001 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
5002 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
5006 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
5008 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
5009 % Grab any single-column material above us.
5012 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a
5013 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output
5014 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is
5015 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In
5016 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal
5017 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this
5018 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case.
5019 \ifvoid\partialpage \else
5020 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}%
5023 \global\setbox\partialpage =
\vbox{%
5024 % Unvbox the main output page.
5026 \kern-
\topskip \kern\baselineskip
5029 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
5031 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
5032 \output =
{\doublecolumnout}%
5034 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
5035 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
5036 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
5037 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
5038 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
5040 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
5041 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
5042 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
5043 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
5044 % as it did when we hard-coded it.
5046 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
5047 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
5050 \doublecolumnhsize =
\hsize
5051 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -
.04154\hsize
5052 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by
2
5053 \hsize =
\doublecolumnhsize
5055 % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
5056 % since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
5060 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
5063 \def\doublecolumnout{%
5064 \splittopskip=
\topskip \splitmaxdepth=
\maxdepth
5065 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
5066 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
5070 \advance\dimen@ by -
\ht\partialpage
5072 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
5073 \setbox0=
\vsplit255 to
\dimen@
\setbox2=
\vsplit255 to
\dimen@
5074 \onepageout\pagesofar
5076 \penalty\outputpenalty
5079 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
5080 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
5084 \hsize =
\doublecolumnhsize
5085 \wd0=
\hsize \wd2=
\hsize
5086 \hbox to
\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
5089 % All done with double columns.
5090 \def\enddoublecolumns{%
5091 % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
5092 % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the
5093 % following situation:
5095 % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
5096 % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
5097 % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last
5098 % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
5099 % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following
5100 % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
5101 % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
5102 % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
5103 % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
5104 % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
5105 % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as
5106 % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
5107 % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
5108 % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
5109 % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
5110 % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
5111 % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
5112 % and the final section into the vbox of \pageheight (see
5113 % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
5115 % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
5116 % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
5120 % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the
5121 % current page, no automatic page break.
5124 % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page,
5125 % though, there will be another page break right after this \output
5126 % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
5127 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
5128 % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be
5129 % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes
5130 % the output somewhat more palatable.)
5131 \global\output =
{\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
5134 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
5136 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
5137 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
5138 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the
5139 % \endgroup where \vsize got restored).
5143 % Called at the end of the double column material.
5144 \def\balancecolumns{%
5145 \setbox0 =
\vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
5147 \advance\dimen@ by
\topskip
5148 \advance\dimen@ by-
\baselineskip
5149 \divide\dimen@ by
2 % target to split to
5150 %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}%
5151 \splittopskip =
\topskip
5152 % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint.
5156 \global\setbox3 =
\copy0
5157 \global\setbox1 =
\vsplit3 to
\dimen@
5159 \global\advance\dimen@ by
1pt
5162 %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}%
5163 \setbox0=
\vbox to
\dimen@
{\unvbox1}%
5164 \setbox2=
\vbox to
\dimen@
{\unvbox3}%
5168 \catcode`\@ =
\other
5171 \message{sectioning,
}
5172 % Chapters, sections, etc.
5174 % Let's start with @part.
5175 \outer\parseargdef\part{\partzzz{#1}}
5179 \vskip.3\vsize % move it down on the page a bit
5181 \noindent \titlefonts\rmisbold #1\par % the text
5182 \let\lastnode=
\empty % no node to associate with
5183 \writetocentry{part
}{#1}{}% but put it in the toc
5184 \headingsoff % no headline or footline on the part page
5189 % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron. But we count the unnumbered
5190 % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
5191 % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
5192 % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
5193 % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
5194 \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno =
10000
5196 \newcount\secno \secno=
0
5197 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=
0
5198 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=
0
5200 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
5201 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
5203 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
5204 % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
5205 % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
5206 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
5208 \def\appendixletter{%
5209 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A
%
5210 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B
%
5211 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C
%
5212 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D
%
5213 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E
%
5214 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F
%
5215 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G
%
5216 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H
%
5217 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I
%
5218 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J
%
5219 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K
%
5220 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L
%
5221 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M
%
5222 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N
%
5223 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O
%
5224 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P
%
5225 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q
%
5226 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R
%
5227 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S
%
5228 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T
%
5229 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U
%
5230 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V
%
5231 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W
%
5232 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X
%
5233 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y
%
5234 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z
%
5235 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
5236 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
5237 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
5238 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
5239 \else\char\the\appendixno
5240 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
5241 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
5243 % Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number
5244 % and name of the chapter. Page headings and footings can use
5245 % these. @section does likewise.
5247 \def\thischapternum{}
5248 \def\thischaptername{}
5250 \def\thissectionnum{}
5251 \def\thissectionname{}
5253 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
5254 \newcount\secbase\secbase=
0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
5256 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
5257 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -
1}
5258 \let\up=
\raisesections % original BFox name
5260 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
5261 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by
1}
5262 \let\down=
\lowersections % original BFox name
5264 % we only have subsub.
5265 \chardef\maxseclevel =
3
5267 % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
5268 % To achieve this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
5269 \chardef\unnlevel =
\maxseclevel
5271 % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
5272 % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
5273 \def\chapheadtype{N
}
5275 % Choose a heading macro
5276 % #1 is heading type
5277 % #2 is heading level
5278 % #3 is text for heading
5279 \def\genhead#1#2#3{%
5280 % Compute the abs. sec. level:
5282 \advance\absseclevel by
\secbase
5283 % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
5284 \ifnum \absseclevel <
0
5287 \ifnum \absseclevel >
3
5294 \ifnum \absseclevel <
\unnlevel
5295 \chardef\unnlevel =
\absseclevel
5298 % Check for appendix sections:
5299 \ifnum \absseclevel =
0
5300 \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
5302 \if \headtype A
\if \chapheadtype N
%
5303 \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter
}%
5306 % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
5307 \ifnum \absseclevel >
\unnlevel
5310 \chardef\unnlevel =
3
5313 % Now print the heading:
5317 \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
5318 \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
5319 \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
5325 \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
5326 \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
5327 \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
5333 \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
5334 \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
5338 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
5342 \def\numhead{\genhead N
}
5343 \def\apphead{\genhead A
}
5344 \def\unnmhead{\genhead U
}
5346 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
5347 % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
5349 % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
5350 % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
5351 \let\chaplevelprefix =
\empty
5353 \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
5355 % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
5356 % as an @include file.
5357 \global\secno=
0 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0
5358 \global\advance\chapno by
1
5361 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.
}%
5364 % \putwordChapter can contain complex things in translations.
5365 \toks0=
\expandafter{\putwordChapter}%
5366 \message{\the\toks0 \space \the\chapno}%
5368 % Write the actual heading.
5369 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered
}{\the\chapno}%
5371 % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
5372 \global\let\section =
\numberedsec
5373 \global\let\subsection =
\numberedsubsec
5374 \global\let\subsubsection =
\numberedsubsubsec
5377 \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally calls appendixzzz
5379 \def\appendixzzz#1{%
5380 \global\secno=
0 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0
5381 \global\advance\appendixno by
1
5382 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.
}%
5385 % \putwordAppendix can contain complex things in translations.
5386 \toks0=
\expandafter{\putwordAppendix}%
5387 \message{\the\toks0 \space \appendixletter}%
5389 \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix
}{\appendixletter}%
5391 \global\let\section =
\appendixsec
5392 \global\let\subsection =
\appendixsubsec
5393 \global\let\subsubsection =
\appendixsubsubsec
5396 % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz:
5397 \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}}
5398 \def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
5399 \global\secno=
0 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0
5400 \global\advance\unnumberedno by
1
5402 % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
5403 \global\let\chaplevelprefix =
\empty
5406 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
5407 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
5408 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
5409 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
5410 % to be executed, not expanded).
5412 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
5413 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
5414 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
5415 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
5418 \message{(
\the\toks0)
}%
5420 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing
}{\the\unnumberedno}%
5422 \global\let\section =
\unnumberedsec
5423 \global\let\subsection =
\unnumberedsubsec
5424 \global\let\subsubsection =
\unnumberedsubsubsec
5427 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
5428 \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
5429 % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break
5430 % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level.
5431 % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04
5432 \let\centerparametersmaybe =
\centerparameters
5434 \let\centerparametersmaybe =
\relax
5437 % @top is like @unnumbered.
5442 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
5444 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\secno by
1
5445 \sectionheading{#1}{sec
}{Ynumbered
}{\the\chapno.
\the\secno}%
5448 % normally calls appendixsectionzzz:
5449 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}}
5450 \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
5451 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\secno by
1
5452 \sectionheading{#1}{sec
}{Yappendix
}{\appendixletter.
\the\secno}%
5454 \let\appendixsec\appendixsection
5456 % normally calls unnumberedseczzz:
5457 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}}
5458 \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
5459 \global\subsecno=
0 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\secno by
1
5460 \sectionheading{#1}{sec
}{Ynothing
}{\the\unnumberedno.
\the\secno}%
5465 % normally calls numberedsubseczzz:
5466 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}}
5467 \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
5468 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\subsecno by
1
5469 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec
}{Ynumbered
}{\the\chapno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno}%
5472 % normally calls appendixsubseczzz:
5473 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}}
5474 \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
5475 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\subsecno by
1
5476 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec
}{Yappendix
}%
5477 {\appendixletter.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno}%
5480 % normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz:
5481 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}}
5482 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
5483 \global\subsubsecno=
0 \global\advance\subsecno by
1
5484 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec
}{Ynothing
}%
5485 {\the\unnumberedno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno}%
5490 % normally numberedsubsubseczzz:
5491 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}}
5492 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
5493 \global\advance\subsubsecno by
1
5494 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec
}{Ynumbered
}%
5495 {\the\chapno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno}%
5498 % normally appendixsubsubseczzz:
5499 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}}
5500 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
5501 \global\advance\subsubsecno by
1
5502 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec
}{Yappendix
}%
5503 {\appendixletter.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno}%
5506 % normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz:
5507 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}}
5508 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
5509 \global\advance\subsubsecno by
1
5510 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec
}{Ynothing
}%
5511 {\the\unnumberedno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno}%
5514 % These macros control what the section commands do, according
5515 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
5516 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
5517 \let\section =
\numberedsec
5518 \let\subsection =
\numberedsubsec
5519 \let\subsubsection =
\numberedsubsubsec
5521 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
5523 % NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such:
5524 % 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit
5525 % overlong headings to fold.
5526 % 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a
5527 % heading is obnoxious; this forbids it.
5528 % 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and
5529 % if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright.
5532 {\advance\chapheadingskip by
10pt
\chapbreak }%
5533 \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
5536 \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
5537 \def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
5538 {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=
10000\tolerance=
5000
5539 \parindent=
0pt
\ptexraggedright
5540 \rmisbold #1\hfill}}%
5541 \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax
5542 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
5545 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
5546 \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec
}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}
5547 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5548 \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec
}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}
5549 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5550 \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec
}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}
5551 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5553 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
5554 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
5555 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
5557 % Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
5558 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<
#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
5560 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
5561 \newskip\chapheadingskip
5563 % Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it.
5564 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-
4000}}
5565 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
5566 % Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will
5567 % get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong. But we don't
5568 % care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page.
5580 \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG
#1\endcsname}
5583 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
5584 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=
\chapbreak
5585 \global\let\pagealignmacro=
\chappager}
5588 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chappager
5589 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=
\chappager
5590 \global\let\pagealignmacro=
\chappager
5591 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
5594 \global\let\contentsalignmacro =
\chapoddpage
5595 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=
\chapoddpage
5596 \global\let\pagealignmacro=
\chapoddpage
5597 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
5603 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
5604 % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
5606 % To test against our argument.
5607 \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing
}
5608 \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc
}
5609 \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix
}
5611 \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
5612 % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
5613 \let\prevchapterdefs=
\lastchapterdefs
5614 \let\prevsectiondefs=
\lastsectiondefs
5615 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
5616 \gdef\thissection{}}%
5619 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5620 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
5621 \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}%
5622 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5623 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
5624 \gdef\thischapter{}}%
5625 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5627 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
5628 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
5629 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
5630 % \noexpand\putwordAppendix avoids expanding indigestible
5631 % commands in some of the translations.
5632 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordAppendix{}
5633 \noexpand\thischapternum:
5634 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
5638 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
5639 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
5640 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
5641 % \noexpand\putwordChapter avoids expanding indigestible
5642 % commands in some of the translations.
5643 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordChapter{}
5644 \noexpand\thischapternum:
5645 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
5649 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
5650 % the preceding space.
5653 % Insert the chapter heading break.
5656 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
5657 % between here and the heading.
5658 \let\prevchapterdefs=
\lastchapterdefs
5659 \let\prevsectiondefs=
\lastsectiondefs
5663 \chapfonts \rmisbold
5665 % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the
5666 % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
5667 % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
5668 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5670 % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
5671 % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
5672 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5674 \def\toctype{unnchap
}%
5675 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5676 \setbox0 =
\hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
5678 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5679 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
5682 \setbox0 =
\hbox{#3\enspace}%
5683 \def\toctype{numchap
}%
5686 % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
5687 % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
5688 % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
5689 \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
5691 % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
5692 % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
5693 % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
5694 % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
5695 % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
5698 % Typeset the actual heading.
5699 \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue.
5700 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=
10000 \tolerance=
5000 \parindent=
0pt
\ptexraggedright
5701 \hangindent=
\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
5704 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
5708 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
5709 \let\centerparametersmaybe =
\relax
5710 \def\centerparameters{%
5711 \advance\rightskip by
3\rightskip
5712 \leftskip =
\rightskip
5717 % I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not
5718 % updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03.
5720 \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF
#1\endcsname}
5722 \def\unnchfopen #1{%
5723 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=
10000\tolerance=
5000
5724 \parindent=
0pt
\ptexraggedright
5725 \rmisbold #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
5727 \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
5728 \vbox to
3in
{\vfil \hbox to
\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to
\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
5731 \def\centerchfopen #1{%
5732 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=
10000\tolerance=
5000
5734 \hfill {\rmisbold #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
5737 \global\let\chapmacro=
\chfopen
5738 \global\let\centerchapmacro=
\centerchfopen}
5741 % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
5742 % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
5744 \newskip\secheadingskip
5745 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-
1000}}
5747 % Subsection titles.
5748 \newskip\subsecheadingskip
5749 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-
500}}
5751 % Subsubsection titles.
5752 \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
5753 \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
5756 % Print any size, any type, section title.
5758 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is
5759 % the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the
5762 \def\seckeyword{sec
}
5764 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
5766 \checkenv{}% should not be in an environment.
5768 % Switch to the right set of fonts.
5769 \csname #2fonts
\endcsname \rmisbold
5771 \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
5774 % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
5775 \let\prevsectiondefs=
\lastsectiondefs
5776 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5777 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5778 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
5779 \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}%
5781 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5782 % Don't redefine \thissection.
5783 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5784 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5786 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
5787 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
5788 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
5789 % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
5790 % commands in some of the translations.
5791 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
5792 \noexpand\thissectionnum:
5793 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
5797 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5799 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
5800 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
5801 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
5802 % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
5803 % commands in some of the translations.
5804 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
5805 \noexpand\thissectionnum:
5806 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
5811 % Go into vertical mode. Usually we'll already be there, but we
5812 % don't want the following whatsit to end up in a preceding paragraph
5813 % if the document didn't happen to have a blank line.
5816 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
5817 % the preceding space.
5820 % Insert space above the heading.
5821 \csname #2headingbreak
\endcsname
5823 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
5824 % between here and the heading.
5825 \let\prevsectiondefs=
\lastsectiondefs
5828 % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
5829 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5832 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5833 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5834 % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
5835 % and don't redefine \lastsection.
5838 \let\sectionlevel=
\empty
5839 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5840 \setbox0 =
\hbox{#4\enspace}%
5842 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5844 \setbox0 =
\hbox{#4\enspace}%
5846 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5849 % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
5850 \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
5852 % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
5853 % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
5856 % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
5857 % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
5858 % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
5859 % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that
5860 % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
5861 % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000.
5864 % Output the actual section heading.
5865 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=
10000 \tolerance=
5000 \parindent=
0pt
\ptexraggedright
5866 \hangindent=
\wd0 % zero if no section number
5869 % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
5870 % Don't allow stretch, though.
5871 \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip
\endcsname
5873 % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
5874 % was followed by glue.
5877 % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
5878 % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
5879 % discardable item.)
5882 % This is purely so the last item on the list is a known \penalty >
5883 % 10000. This is so \startdefun can avoid allowing breakpoints after
5884 % section headings. Otherwise, it would insert a valid breakpoint between:
5885 % @section sec-whatever
5886 % @deffn def-whatever
5892 % Table of contents.
5895 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
5896 % Called from @chapter, etc.
5898 % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
5899 % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
5900 % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
5901 % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
5902 % destination to jump to.
5904 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
5905 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
5906 % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
5907 % table of contents chapter openings themselves.
5909 \newif\iftocfileopened
5910 \def\omitkeyword{omit
}%
5912 \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
5913 \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
5914 \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
5915 \iftocfileopened\else
5916 \immediate\openout\tocfile =
\jobname.toc
5917 \global\tocfileopenedtrue
5923 \write\tocfile{@
#1entry
{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
5929 % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
5930 % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
5931 % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
5932 % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
5933 % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
5934 % `1', and two named `2'.
5935 \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi
5939 % These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
5940 % fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
5941 % with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
5943 \def\activecatcodes{%
5956 % Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
5960 \input \tocreadfilename
5963 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=
1in
5964 \newcount\savepageno
5965 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -
1
5967 % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
5969 \def\startcontents#1{%
5970 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
5971 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
5972 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
5973 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se>
5975 \immediate\closeout\tocfile
5977 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
5978 % It is abundantly clear what they are.
5979 \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc
}{}%
5981 \savepageno =
\pageno
5982 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
5983 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
5984 \advance\hsize by -
\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
5986 % Roman numerals for page numbers.
5987 \ifnum \pageno>
0 \global\pageno =
\lastnegativepageno \fi
5990 % redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on
5991 % \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
5993 \def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc
}
5995 % Normal (long) toc.
5998 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
5999 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
6004 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
6010 \lastnegativepageno =
\pageno
6011 \global\pageno =
\savepageno
6014 % And just the chapters.
6015 \def\summarycontents{%
6016 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
6018 \let\partentry =
\shortpartentry
6019 \let\numchapentry =
\shortchapentry
6020 \let\appentry =
\shortchapentry
6021 \let\unnchapentry =
\shortunnchapentry
6022 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
6024 \let\rm=
\shortcontrm \let\bf=
\shortcontbf
6025 \let\sl=
\shortcontsl \let\tt=
\shortconttt
6027 \hyphenpenalty =
10000
6028 \advance\baselineskip by
1pt
% Open it up a little.
6029 \def\numsecentry#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{}
6030 \let\appsecentry =
\numsecentry
6031 \let\unnsecentry =
\numsecentry
6032 \let\numsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
6033 \let\appsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
6034 \let\unnsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
6035 \let\numsubsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
6036 \let\appsubsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
6037 \let\unnsubsubsecentry =
\numsecentry
6038 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
6044 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
6046 \lastnegativepageno =
\pageno
6047 \global\pageno =
\savepageno
6049 \let\shortcontents =
\summarycontents
6051 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
6052 % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
6054 \def\shortchaplabel#1{%
6055 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
6056 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
6057 % But use \hss just in case.
6058 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
6059 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
6061 % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
6062 % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
6063 % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
6064 % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
6065 % there are before deciding ...
6066 \hbox to
1em
{#1\hss}%
6069 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
6070 % The first argument is the chapter or section name.
6071 % The last argument is the page number.
6072 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
6074 % Parts, in the main contents. Replace the part number, which doesn't
6075 % exist, with an empty box. Let's hope all the numbers have the same width.
6076 % Also ignore the page number, which is conventionally not printed.
6077 \def\numeralbox{\setbox0=
\hbox{8}\hbox to
\wd0{\hfil}}
6078 \def\partentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\numeralbox\labelspace#1}{}}
6080 % Parts, in the short toc.
6081 \def\shortpartentry#1#2#3#4{%
6083 \vskip.5\baselineskip plus
.15\baselineskip minus
.1\baselineskip
6084 \shortchapentry{{\bf #1}}{\numeralbox}{}{}%
6087 % Chapters, in the main contents.
6088 \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6090 % Chapters, in the short toc.
6091 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
6092 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
6093 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
6096 % Appendices, in the main contents.
6097 % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
6099 \def\appendixbox#1{%
6100 % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
6101 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M
}%
6102 \hbox to
\wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
6104 \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6106 % Unnumbered chapters.
6107 \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
6108 \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
6111 \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6112 \let\appsecentry=
\numsecentry
6113 \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
6116 \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6117 \let\appsubsecentry=
\numsubsecentry
6118 \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
6120 % And subsubsections.
6121 \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6122 \let\appsubsubsecentry=
\numsubsubsecentry
6123 \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
6125 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
6126 % Same as \defaultparindent.
6127 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent =
15pt
6129 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
6132 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
6133 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
6134 \def\dochapentry#1#2{%
6135 \penalty-
300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus
.33\baselineskip minus
.25\baselineskip
6138 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
6140 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus
.1\baselineskip
6143 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
6144 \secentryfonts \leftskip=
\tocindent
6145 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
6148 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
6149 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=
2\tocindent
6150 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
6153 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
6154 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=
3\tocindent
6155 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
6158 % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
6159 \let\tocentry =
\entry
6161 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
6162 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
6164 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
6165 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
6167 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
6168 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
6169 \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
6170 \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
6173 \message{environments,
}
6174 % @foo ... @end foo.
6176 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw TeX temporarily.
6177 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
6178 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain @ character.
6181 \setupmarkupstyle{tex
}%
6182 \catcode `\\=
0 \catcode `\
{=
1 \catcode `\
}=
2
6183 \catcode `\$=
3 \catcode `\&=
4 \catcode `\#=
6
6184 \catcode `\^=
7 \catcode `
\_=
8 \catcode `\~=
\active \let~=
\tie
6195 % ' is active in math mode (mathcode"8000). So reset it, and all our
6196 % other math active characters (just in case), to plain's definitions.
6200 \let\bullet=
\ptexbullet
6205 \let\equiv=
\ptexequiv
6208 \let\indent=
\ptexindent
6209 \let\noindent=
\ptexnoindent
6216 \expandafter \let\csname top
\endcsname=
\ptextop % outer
6217 \let\frenchspacing=
\plainfrenchspacing
6219 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
6220 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$
\mathsurround=
0pt
\endldots\,$
\fi}%
6223 % There is no need to define \Etex.
6225 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
6226 % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
6227 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
6229 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
6230 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=
0.4in
6232 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
6233 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
6235 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
6237 % This space is always present above and below environments.
6238 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount =
0pt
6240 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
6241 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
6242 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
6243 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
6245 \def\aboveenvbreak{{%
6246 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
6247 % \sectionheading, q.v.
6248 \ifnum \lastpenalty=
10000 \else
6249 \advance\envskipamount by
\parskip
6251 \ifdim\lastskip<
\envskipamount
6253 % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
6255 \ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000 \penalty-
50 \fi
6256 \vskip\envskipamount
6261 \let\afterenvbreak =
\aboveenvbreak
6263 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
6264 % also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
6265 \let\nonarrowing=
\relax
6267 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
6268 % environment contents.
6269 \font\circle=lcircle10
6271 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
6272 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
6273 \circthick=
\fontdimen8\circle
6275 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'
013\hskip -
6pt
}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
6276 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt
\circle\char'
010}}
6277 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'
012\hskip -
6pt
}}
6278 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt
\circle\char'
011}}
6279 \def\carttop{\hbox to
\cartouter{\hskip\lskip
6280 \ctl\leaders\hrule height
\circthick\hfil\ctr
6282 \def\cartbot{\hbox to
\cartouter{\hskip\lskip
6283 \cbl\leaders\hrule height
\circthick\hfil\cbr
6286 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
6289 \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
6291 \lskip=
\leftskip \rskip=
\rightskip
6292 \leftskip=
0pt
\rightskip=
0pt
% we want these *outside*.
6293 \cartinner=
\hsize \advance\cartinner by-
\lskip
6294 \advance\cartinner by-
\rskip
6296 \advance\cartouter by
18.4pt
% allow for 3pt kerns on either
6297 % side, and for 6pt waste from
6298 % each corner char, and rule thickness
6299 \normbskip=
\baselineskip \normpskip=
\parskip \normlskip=
\lineskip
6300 % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin.
6301 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
6303 % If this cartouche directly follows a sectioning command, we need the
6304 % \parskip glue (backspaced over by default) or the cartouche can
6305 % collide with the section heading.
6306 \ifnum\lastpenalty>
10000 \vskip\parskip \fi
6309 \baselineskip=
0pt
\parskip=
0pt
\lineskip=
0pt
6317 \baselineskip=
\normbskip
6318 \lineskip=
\normlskip
6321 \comment % For explanation, see the end of def\group.
6336 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
6338 \newdimen\nonfillparindent
6341 \hfuzz =
12pt
% Don't be fussy
6342 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
6343 \let\par =
\lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
6344 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
6346 % Turn off paragraph indentation but redefine \indent to emulate
6347 % the normal \indent.
6348 \nonfillparindent=
\parindent
6350 \let\indent\nonfillindent
6352 \emergencystretch =
0pt
% don't try to avoid overfull boxes
6353 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
6354 \advance \leftskip by
\lispnarrowing
6355 \exdentamount=
\lispnarrowing
6357 \let\nonarrowing =
\relax
6359 \let\exdent=
\nofillexdent
6364 % We want to swallow spaces (but not other tokens) after the fake
6365 % @indent in our nonfill-environments, where spaces are normally
6366 % active and set to @tie, resulting in them not being ignored after
6368 \gdef\nonfillindent{\futurelet\temp\nonfillindentcheck}%
6369 \gdef\nonfillindentcheck{%
6371 \expandafter\nonfillindentgobble%
6373 \leavevmode\nonfillindentbox%
6377 \def\nonfillindentgobble#1{\nonfillindent}
6378 \def\nonfillindentbox{\hbox to
\nonfillparindent{\hss}}
6380 % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
6381 % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
6382 % This affects the following displayed environments:
6383 % @example, @display, @format, @lisp
6385 \def\smallword{small
}
6386 \def\nosmallword{nosmall
}
6387 \let\SETdispenvsize\relax
6388 \def\setnormaldispenv{%
6389 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
6390 % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
6391 % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
6392 % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
6393 % to change the fonts afterward.
6394 \ifnum \lastpenalty=
10000 \else \endgraf \fi
6395 \smallexamplefonts \rm
6398 \def\setsmalldispenv{%
6399 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
6401 \ifnum \lastpenalty=
10000 \else \endgraf \fi
6402 \smallexamplefonts \rm
6406 % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
6407 % Let's do it in one command. #1 is the env name, #2 the definition.
6408 \def\makedispenvdef#1#2{%
6409 \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}%
6410 \expandafter\envdef\csname small
#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}%
6411 \expandafter\let\csname E
#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
6412 \expandafter\let\csname Esmall
#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
6415 % Define two environment synonyms (#1 and #2) for an environment.
6416 \def\maketwodispenvdef#1#2#3{%
6417 \makedispenvdef{#1}{#3}%
6418 \makedispenvdef{#2}{#3}%
6421 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font;
6422 % @example: same as @lisp.
6424 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
6425 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
6427 \maketwodispenvdef{lisp
}{example
}{%
6429 \tt\setupmarkupstyle{example
}%
6430 \let\kbdfont =
\kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
6431 \gobble % eat return
6433 % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
6435 \makedispenvdef{display
}{%
6440 % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
6442 \makedispenvdef{format
}{%
6443 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
6448 % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
6450 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
6454 \let\Eflushleft =
\afterenvbreak
6458 \envdef\flushright{%
6459 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
6461 \advance\leftskip by
0pt plus
1fill
\relax
6464 \let\Eflushright =
\afterenvbreak
6467 % @raggedright does more-or-less normal line breaking but no right
6468 % justification. From plain.tex.
6469 \envdef\raggedright{%
6470 \rightskip0pt plus2em
\spaceskip.3333em
\xspaceskip.5em
\relax
6472 \let\Eraggedright\par
6474 \envdef\raggedleft{%
6475 \parindent=
0pt
\leftskip0pt plus2em
6476 \spaceskip.3333em
\xspaceskip.5em
\parfillskip=
0pt
6477 \hbadness=
10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
6478 % badness reporting.
6480 \let\Eraggedleft\par
6482 \envdef\raggedcenter{%
6483 \parindent=
0pt
\rightskip0pt plus1em
\leftskip0pt plus1em
6484 \spaceskip.3333em
\xspaceskip.5em
\parfillskip=
0pt
6485 \hbadness=
10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
6486 % badness reporting.
6488 \let\Eraggedcenter\par
6491 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
6492 % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
6493 % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
6494 % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
6496 \makedispenvdef{quotation
}{\quotationstart}
6498 \def\quotationstart{%
6499 {\parskip=
0pt
\aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
6502 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
6503 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
6504 \advance\leftskip by
\lispnarrowing
6505 \advance\rightskip by
\lispnarrowing
6506 \exdentamount =
\lispnarrowing
6508 \let\nonarrowing =
\relax
6510 \parsearg\quotationlabel
6513 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
6514 % doing normal filling.
6518 \ifx\quotationauthor\thisisundefined\else
6520 \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---
\quotationauthor}%
6522 {\parskip=
0pt
\afterenvbreak}%
6524 \def\Esmallquotation{\Equotation}
6526 % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
6527 \def\quotationlabel#1{%
6529 \ifx\temp\empty \else
6535 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
6536 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
6537 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
6538 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
6540 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
6542 % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
6543 % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
6546 \do\
\do\\
\do\
{\do\
}\do\$
\do\&
%
6547 \do\#
\do\^
\do\^^K
\do\_\do\^^A
\do\%
\do\~
%
6548 \do\<
\do\>
\do\|
\do\@
\do+
\do\"
%
6549 % Don't do the quotes -- if we do, @set txicodequoteundirected and
6550 % @set txicodequotebacktick will not have effect on @verb and
6551 % @verbatim, and ?` and !` ligatures won't get disabled.
6556 \def\uncatcodespecials{%
6557 \def\do#
#1{\catcode`#
#1=
\other}\dospecials}
6559 % Setup for the @verb command.
6561 % Eight spaces for a tab
6563 \catcode`\^^I=
\active
6564 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=
\active\def^^I
{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \
}}
6568 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
6569 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
6570 \setupmarkupstyle{verb
}%
6572 % Respect line breaks,
6573 % print special symbols as themselves, and
6574 % make each space count
6575 % must do in this order:
6576 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
6579 % Setup for the @verbatim environment
6581 % Real tab expansion.
6582 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=
\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=
8\wd0 % tab amount
6584 % We typeset each line of the verbatim in an \hbox, so we can handle
6585 % tabs. The \global is in case the verbatim line starts with an accent,
6586 % or some other command that starts with a begin-group. Otherwise, the
6587 % entire \verbbox would disappear at the corresponding end-group, before
6588 % it is typeset. Meanwhile, we can't have nested verbatim commands
6589 % (can we?), so the \global won't be overwriting itself.
6591 \def\starttabbox{\global\setbox\verbbox=
\hbox\bgroup}
6594 \catcode`\^^I=
\active
6596 \catcode`\^^I=
\active
6597 \def^^I
{\leavevmode\egroup
6598 \dimen\verbbox=
\wd\verbbox % the width so far, or since the previous tab
6599 \divide\dimen\verbbox by
\tabw
6600 \multiply\dimen\verbbox by
\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
6601 \advance\dimen\verbbox by
\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
6602 \wd\verbbox=
\dimen\verbbox \box\verbbox \starttabbox
6607 % start the verbatim environment.
6608 \def\setupverbatim{%
6609 \let\nonarrowing = t
%
6611 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
6612 % The \leavevmode here is for blank lines. Otherwise, we would
6613 % never \starttabox and the \egroup would end verbatim mode.
6614 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box\verbbox\endgraf}%
6616 \setupmarkupstyle{verbatim
}%
6617 % Respect line breaks,
6618 % print special symbols as themselves, and
6619 % make each space count.
6620 % Must do in this order:
6621 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
6622 \everypar{\starttabbox}%
6625 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
6626 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
6627 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
6629 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
6631 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
6633 \catcode`
[=
1\catcode`
]=
2\catcode`\
{=
\other\catcode`\
}=
\other
6634 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next#
#1#1}[#
#1\endgroup]\next]
6637 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
6640 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
6641 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
6643 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
6645 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
6646 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
6647 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
6649 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
6654 % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
6655 % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
6656 % line in the output.
6657 \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M
#2@end verbatim
{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim
}%
6658 % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
6659 % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
6663 \setupverbatim\doverbatim
6665 \let\Everbatim =
\afterenvbreak
6668 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
6670 \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
6672 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
6674 \makevalueexpandable
6676 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
6677 \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @verbatiminclude of
#1^^J
}%
6683 % @copying ... @end copying.
6684 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
6686 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
6687 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
6688 % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
6689 % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
6690 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
6691 % possible is very desirable.
6693 \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
6694 \def\docopying#1@end copying
{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
6696 \def\insertcopying{%
6698 \parindent =
0pt
% paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
6699 \scanexp\copyingtext
6707 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=
.4in
6708 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=
50pt
6709 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=
18pt
6710 \newcount\defunpenalty
6712 % Start the processing of @deffn:
6714 \ifnum\lastpenalty<
10000
6716 \defunpenalty=
10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
6717 % following @def command, see below.
6719 % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
6720 % which is there to keep the function description together with its
6721 % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
6722 % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
6723 % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
6724 % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
6725 % a break between a section heading and a defun.
6727 % As a further refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
6728 % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
6729 % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
6731 \ifnum\lastpenalty=
10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=
10002 \fi
6733 % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
6734 % But do insert the glue.
6735 \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
6739 \advance\leftskip by
\defbodyindent
6740 \exdentamount=
\defbodyindent
6744 % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
6747 % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
6748 % It's not a great place, though.
6749 \ifnum\lastpenalty=
10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=
10002 \fi
6751 % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
6752 \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
6754 \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
6756 % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
6758 \def\printdefunline#1#2{%
6760 % call \deffnheader:
6763 \interlinepenalty =
10000
6764 \advance\rightskip by
0pt plus
1fil
\relax
6766 \nobreak\vskip -
\parskip
6767 \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
6768 % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
6769 % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
6774 \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
6776 % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
6777 % the only thing remaining is to define \deffnheader.
6780 \expandafter\let\csname E
#1\endcsname =
\Edefun
6781 \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
6782 \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x
}\makecsname{#1header
}}%
6786 % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader
6788 % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
6789 % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
6791 \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
6794 \doingtypefnfalse % distinguish typed functions from all else
6795 \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
6797 \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
6801 \newif\ifdoingtypefn % doing typed function?
6802 \newif\ifrettypeownline % typeset return type on its own line?
6804 % @deftypefnnewline on|off says whether the return type of typed functions
6805 % are printed on their own line. This affects @deftypefn, @deftypefun,
6806 % @deftypeop, and @deftypemethod.
6808 \parseargdef\deftypefnnewline{%
6811 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl
\endcsname
6813 \else\ifx\temp\offword
6814 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl
\endcsname
6817 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
6818 \errmessage{Unknown @txideftypefnnl value `
\temp',
6823 % Untyped functions:
6825 % @deffn category name args
6826 \makedefun{deffn
}{\deffngeneral{}}
6828 % @deffn category class name args
6829 \makedefun{defop
}#1 {\defopon{#1\
\putwordon}}
6831 % \defopon {category on}class name args
6832 \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\
\code{#2}}{#1\
\code{#2}} }
6834 % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
6836 \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
6837 % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
6838 \dosubind{fn
}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
6839 \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
6844 % @deftypefn category type name args
6845 \makedefun{deftypefn
}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
6847 % @deftypeop category class type name args
6848 \makedefun{deftypeop
}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\
\putwordon}}
6850 % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
6851 \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\
\code{#2}}{#1\
\code{#2}} }
6853 % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
6855 \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
6856 \dosubind{fn
}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
6858 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
6863 % @deftypevr category type var args
6864 \makedefun{deftypevr
}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
6866 % @deftypecv category class type var args
6867 \makedefun{deftypecv
}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\
\putwordof}}
6869 % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
6870 \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\
\code{#2}}{#1\
\code{#2}} }
6872 % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
6874 \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
6875 \dosubind{vr
}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
6876 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
6879 % Untyped variables:
6881 % @defvr category var args
6882 \makedefun{defvr
}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
6884 % @defcv category class var args
6885 \makedefun{defcv
}#1 {\defcvof{#1\
\putwordof}}
6887 % \defcvof {category of}class var args
6888 \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
6892 % @deftp category name args
6893 \makedefun{deftp
}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
6894 \doind{tp
}{\code{#2}}%
6895 \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
6898 % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
6899 \makedefun{defun
}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
6900 \makedefun{defmac
}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
6901 \makedefun{defspec
}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
6902 \makedefun{deftypefun
}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
6903 \makedefun{defvar
}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
6904 \makedefun{defopt
}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
6905 \makedefun{deftypevar
}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
6906 \makedefun{defmethod
}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
6907 \makedefun{deftypemethod
}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
6908 \makedefun{defivar
}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
6909 \makedefun{deftypeivar
}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
6911 % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
6912 % #1 is the category, such as "Function".
6913 % #2 is the return type, if any.
6914 % #3 is the function name.
6916 % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
6918 \def\defname#1#2#3{%
6920 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
6921 \advance\leftskip by -
\defbodyindent
6923 % Determine if we are typesetting the return type of a typed function
6924 % on a line by itself.
6925 \rettypeownlinefalse
6926 \ifdoingtypefn % doing a typed function specifically?
6927 % then check user option for putting return type on its own line:
6928 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxideftypefnnl
\endcsname\relax \else
6933 % How we'll format the category name. Putting it in brackets helps
6934 % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
6937 \setbox0=
\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
6939 % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape. We'll always have at
6943 % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
6944 % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
6945 \dimen0=
\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -
\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by
\rightskip
6947 % If doing a return type on its own line, we'll have another line.
6949 \advance\tempnum by
1
6950 \def\maybeshapeline{0in
\hsize}%
6952 \def\maybeshapeline{}%
6955 % The continuations:
6956 \dimen2=
\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -
\defargsindent
6958 % The final paragraph shape:
6959 \parshape \tempnum 0in
\dimen0 \maybeshapeline \defargsindent \dimen2
6961 % Put the category name at the right margin.
6964 \hfil\box0 \kern-
\hsize
6965 % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
6967 % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
6970 % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
6971 \tolerance=
10000 \hbadness=
10000
6972 \exdentamount=
\defbodyindent
6974 % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
6975 % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
6976 % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
6977 % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
6978 % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
6979 % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
6980 % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
6981 % one has made identifiers using them :).
6983 \def\temp{#2}% text of the return type
6984 \ifx\temp\empty\else
6985 \tclose{\temp}% typeset the return type
6987 % put return type on its own line; prohibit line break following:
6988 \hfil\vadjust{\nobreak}\break
6990 \space % type on same line, so just followed by a space
6992 \fi % no return type
6993 #3% output function name
6995 {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm
6998 % arguments will be output next, if any.
7001 % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
7002 % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
7003 % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
7004 % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
7007 % use sl by default (not ttsl),
7009 \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=
0
7011 % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
7012 % want a way to get ttsl. Let's try @var for that.
7013 \def\var#
#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var
}\ttslanted{#
#1}}}%
7015 \sl\hyphenchar\font=
45
7018 % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
7021 \catcode`\(=
\active \catcode`\)=
\active
7022 \catcode`\
[=
\active \catcode`\
]=
\active
7026 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
7027 \let\lparen = (
\let\rparen = )
7029 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
7030 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
7031 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
7034 \global\let(=
\lparen \global\let)=
\rparen
7035 \global\let[=
\lbrack \global\let]=
\rbrack
7038 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=
\opnr\let)=
\clnr\let[=
\lbrb\let]=
\rbrb}
7039 \gdef\magicamp{\let&=
\amprm}
7042 \newcount\parencount
7044 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
7046 \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&
#1 }}
7050 % At the first level, print parens in roman,
7051 % otherwise use the default font.
7052 \ifnum \parencount=
1 \rm \fi
7054 % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
7055 % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
7059 \def\infirstlevel#1{%
7066 \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
7069 \global\advance\parencount by
1
7071 \infirstlevel \bfafterword
7076 \global\advance\parencount by -
1
7079 \newcount\brackcount
7081 \global\advance\brackcount by
1
7086 \global\advance\brackcount by -
1
7089 \def\checkparencounts{%
7090 \ifnum\parencount=
0 \else \badparencount \fi
7091 \ifnum\brackcount=
0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
7093 % these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually
7094 % has such constructs (when documenting function pointers).
7095 \def\badparencount{%
7096 \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...
}%
7097 \global\parencount=
0
7099 \def\badbrackcount{%
7100 \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...
}%
7101 \global\brackcount=
0
7108 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
7109 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
7110 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
7111 \newwrite\macscribble
7114 \immediate\openout\macscribble=
\jobname.tmp
7115 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
7116 \immediate\closeout\macscribble
7121 \def\scanmacro#1{\begingroup
7123 \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
7125 % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
7126 % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
7127 % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had
7128 % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears
7129 % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04
7130 \catcode`\@=
0 \catcode`\\=
\active \escapechar=`\@
7132 % ... and for \example:
7135 % The \empty here causes a following catcode 5 newline to be eaten as
7136 % part of reading whitespace after a control sequence. It does not
7137 % eat a catcode 13 newline. There's no good way to handle the two
7138 % cases (untried: maybe e-TeX's \everyeof could help, though plain TeX
7139 % would then have different behavior). See the Macro Details node in
7140 % the manual for the workaround we recommend for macros and
7141 % line-oriented commands.
7143 \scantokens{#1\empty}%
7147 \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}%
7151 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
7152 \newtoks\macname % Macro name
7153 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
7155 % List of all defined macros in the form
7156 % \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2...
7157 % Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
7158 % if there is a need.
7161 % Add the macro to \macrolist
7162 \def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
7163 \def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
7164 \toks0 =
\expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}%
7165 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
7169 % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
7170 % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
7171 % (except of course we have to play expansion games).
7175 \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
7179 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
7180 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
7182 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@
\expandafter{#1 }}
7183 \gdef\trim@
#1{\trim@@ @
#1 @
#1 @ @@
}
7184 \gdef\trim@@
#1@
#2@
#3@@
{\trim@@@
\empty #2 @
}
7186 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@
#1 } #2@
{#1}
7189 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
7190 {\catcode`\^^M=
\other \catcode`
\Q=
3%
7191 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ
}%
7192 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ
{\eatcrb#1Q
}%
7193 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q
#2Q
{#1}%
7196 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
7197 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
7198 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \
7199 % to recognize macro arguments; this is the job of \mbodybackslash.
7201 % Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate
7202 % them to avoid their expansion. Must do this non-globally, to
7203 % confine the change to the current group.
7205 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
7206 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
7207 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
7209 \def\scanctxt{% used as subroutine
7219 \ifx\declaredencoding\ascii \else \setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other \fi
7222 \def\scanargctxt{% used for copying and captions, not macros.
7225 \catcode`\^^M=
\other
7228 \def\macrobodyctxt{% used for @macro definitions
7232 \catcode`\^^M=
\other
7236 \def\macroargctxt{% used when scanning invocations
7240 % why catcode 0 for \ in the above? To recognize \\ \{ \} as "escapes"
7241 % for the single characters \ { }. Thus, we end up with the "commands"
7242 % that would be written @\ @{ @} in a Texinfo document.
7244 % We already have @{ and @}. For @\, we define it here, and only for
7245 % this purpose, to produce a typewriter backslash (so, the @\ that we
7246 % define for @math can't be used with @macro calls):
7248 \def\\
{\normalbackslash}%
7250 % We would like to do this for \, too, since that is what makeinfo does.
7251 % But it is not possible, because Texinfo already has a command @, for a
7252 % cedilla accent. Documents must use @comma{} instead.
7254 % \anythingelse will almost certainly be an error of some kind.
7257 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
7258 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
7259 % where N is the macro parameter number.
7260 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
7261 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
7263 {\catcode`@=
0 @catcode`@\=@active
7264 @gdef@usembodybackslash
{@let\=@mbodybackslash
}
7265 @gdef@mbodybackslash
#1\
{@csname macarg.
#1@endcsname
}
7267 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.
\endcsname{\realbackslash}
7269 \def\margbackslash#1{\char`\
#1 }
7271 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
7272 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
7275 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
7276 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
7279 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;
%
7280 \if\paramno>
256\relax
7281 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
7282 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
7283 \errmessage{You need eTeX to compile a file with macros with more than
256 arguments
}
7287 \if1\csname ismacro.
\the\macname\endcsname
7288 \message{Warning: redefining
\the\macname}%
7290 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
7291 \else \errmessage{Macro name
\the\macname\space already defined
}\fi
7292 \global\cslet{macsave.
\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
7293 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.
\the\macname\endcsname=
1%
7294 \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
7296 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
7297 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
7298 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
7301 \parseargdef\unmacro{%
7302 \if1\csname ismacro.
#1\endcsname
7303 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.
#1}%
7304 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.
#1\endcsname=
0%
7305 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
7307 \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
7308 \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo
7309 \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
7312 \errmessage{Macro
#1 not defined
}%
7316 % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
7317 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
7323 \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1%
7327 % This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a
7328 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
7329 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
7330 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
7331 \def\getargsxxx#1#
{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
7332 \def\getmacname#1 #2\relax{\macname=
{#1}}
7333 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
7335 % For macro processing make @ a letter so that we can make Texinfo private macro names.
7336 \edef\texiatcatcode{\the\catcode`\@
}
7337 \catcode `@=
11\relax
7339 % Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist
7340 % so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.BLAH for each BLAH
7341 % in the params list to some hook where the argument si to be expanded. If
7342 % there are less than 10 arguments that hook is to be replaced by ##N where N
7343 % is the position in that list, that is to say the macro arguments are to be
7344 % defined `a la TeX in the macro body.
7346 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
7348 % We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions.
7349 % The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something
7350 % unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine
7351 % it to # just before using the token list produced.
7353 % The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before
7354 % the macro is used.
7356 % If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used, where the
7357 % hook remains in the body, and when macro is to be expanded the body is
7358 % processed again to replace the arguments.
7360 % In that case, the hook is \the\toks N-1, and we simply set \toks N-1 to the
7361 % argument N value and then \edef the body (nothing else will expand because of
7362 % the catcode regime underwhich the body was input).
7364 % If you compile with TeX (not eTeX), and you have macros with 10 or more
7365 % arguments, you need that no macro has more than 256 arguments, otherwise an
7366 % error is produced.
7367 \def\parsemargdef#1;
{%
7368 \paramno=
0\def\paramlist{}%
7370 \let\xeatspaces\relax
7371 \parsemargdefxxx#1,;,
%
7372 % In case that there are 10 or more arguments we parse again the arguments
7373 % list to set new definitions for the \macarg.BLAH macros corresponding to
7374 % each BLAH argument. It was anyhow needed to parse already once this list
7375 % in order to count the arguments, and as macros with at most 9 arguments
7376 % are by far more frequent than macro with 10 or more arguments, defining
7377 % twice the \macarg.BLAH macros does not cost too much processing power.
7378 \ifnum\paramno<
10\relax\else
7380 \parsemmanyargdef@@
#1,;,
% 10 or more arguments
7383 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,
{%
7384 \if#1;
\let\next=
\relax
7385 \else \let\next=
\parsemargdefxxx
7386 \advance\paramno by
1
7387 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.
\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
7388 {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
7389 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,
}%
7392 \def\parsemmanyargdef@@
#1,
{%
7393 \if#1;
\let\next=
\relax
7395 \let\next=
\parsemmanyargdef@@
7396 \edef\tempb{\eatspaces{#1}}%
7397 \expandafter\def\expandafter\tempa
7398 \expandafter{\csname macarg.
\tempb\endcsname}%
7399 % Note that we need some extra \noexpand\noexpand, this is because we
7400 % don't want \the to be expanded in the \parsermacbody as it uses an
7402 \expandafter\edef\tempa
7403 {\noexpand\noexpand\noexpand\the\toks\the\paramno}%
7404 \advance\paramno by
1\relax
7407 % These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies.
7408 % (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
7411 \catcode `\@
\texiatcatcode
7412 \long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro
%
7413 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
7414 \long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro
%
7415 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
7416 \catcode `\@=
11\relax
7421 \long\def\nillm@
{\nil@
}%
7423 % This macro is expanded during the Texinfo macro expansion, not during its
7424 % definition. It gets all the arguments values and assigns them to macros
7427 % #1 is the macro name
7428 % #2 is the list of argument names
7429 % #3 is the list of argument values
7430 \def\getargvals@
#1#2#3{%
7431 \def\macargdeflist@
{}%
7432 \def\saveparamlist@
{#2}% Need to keep a copy for parameter expansion.
7433 \def\paramlist{#2,
\nil@
}%
7437 \def\argvaluelist{#3,
\nil@
}%
7448 \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
7449 % Some sanity check needed here that \argvaluelist is also empty.
7450 \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
7452 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
7453 \errmessage{Too many arguments in macro `
\macroname'!
}%
7455 \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
7457 \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
7458 % No more arguments values passed to macro. Set remaining named-arg
7460 \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
7462 % pop current arg name into \@tempb
7463 \def\@tempa#
#1{\pop@
{\@tempb
}{\paramlist}#
#1\endargs@
}%
7464 \expandafter\@tempa
\expandafter{\paramlist}%
7465 % pop current argument value into \@tempc
7466 \def\@tempa#
#1{\longpop@
{\@tempc
}{\argvaluelist}#
#1\endargs@
}%
7467 \expandafter\@tempa
\expandafter{\argvaluelist}%
7468 % Here \@tempb is the current arg name and \@tempc is the current arg value.
7469 % First place the new argument macro definition into \@tempd
7470 \expandafter\macname\expandafter{\@tempc
}%
7471 \expandafter\let\csname macarg.\@tempb
\endcsname\relax
7472 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempe
\expandafter{%
7473 \csname macarg.\@tempb
\endcsname}%
7474 \edef\@tempd
{\long\def\@tempe
{\the\macname}}%
7475 \push@\@tempd
\macargdeflist@
7476 \let\next\getargvals@@
7483 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\def
7484 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter#2%
7485 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter{%
7489 % Replace arguments by their values in the macro body, and place the result
7491 \def\macvalstoargs@
{%
7492 % To do this we use the property that token registers that are \the'ed
7493 % within an \edef expand only once. So we are going to place all argument
7494 % values into respective token registers.
7496 % First we save the token context, and initialize argument numbering.
7499 % Then, for each argument number #N, we place the corresponding argument
7500 % value into a new token list register \toks#N
7501 \expandafter\putargsintokens@
\saveparamlist@,;,
%
7502 % Then, we expand the body so that argument are replaced by their
7503 % values. The trick for values not to be expanded themselves is that they
7504 % are within tokens and that tokens expand only once in an \edef .
7505 \edef\@tempc
{\csname mac.
\macroname .body
\endcsname}%
7506 % Now we restore the token stack pointer to free the token list registers
7507 % which we have used, but we make sure that expanded body is saved after
7511 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa
\expandafter{\@tempc
}%
7514 \def\macargexpandinbody@
{%
7515 %% Define the named-macro outside of this group and then close this group.
7519 % First the replace in body the macro arguments by their values, the result
7522 % Then we point at the \norecurse or \gobble (for recursive) macro value
7524 \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempb
\csname mac.
\macroname .recurse
\endcsname
7525 % Depending on whether it is recursive or not, we need some tailing
7532 % And now we do the real job:
7533 \edef\@tempd
{\noexpand\@tempb
{\macroname}\noexpand\scanmacro{\@tempa
}\@tempc
}%
7537 \def\putargsintokens@
#1,
{%
7538 \if#1;
\let\next\relax
7540 \let\next\putargsintokens@
7541 % First we allocate the new token list register, and give it a temporary
7543 \toksdef\@tempb
\the\paramno
7544 % Then we place the argument value into that token list register.
7545 \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempa
\csname macarg.
#1\endcsname
7546 \expandafter\@tempb
\expandafter{\@tempa
}%
7547 \advance\paramno by
1\relax
7552 % Save the token stack pointer into macro #1
7553 \def\texisavetoksstackpoint#1{\edef#1{\the\@cclvi
}}
7554 % Restore the token stack pointer from number in macro #1
7555 \def\texirestoretoksstackpoint#1{\expandafter\mathchardef\expandafter\@cclvi
#1\relax}
7556 % newtoks that can be used non \outer .
7557 \def\texinonouternewtoks{\alloc@
5\toks \toksdef \@cclvi
}
7559 % Tailing missing arguments are set to empty
7560 \def\setemptyargvalues@
{%
7561 \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
7562 \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
7564 \expandafter\setemptyargvaluesparser@
\paramlist\endargs@
7565 \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
7570 \def\setemptyargvaluesparser@
#1,
#2\endargs@
{%
7571 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa
\expandafter{%
7572 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.
#1\endcsname{}}%
7573 \push@\@tempa
\macargdeflist@
7577 % #1 is the element target macro
7578 % #2 is the list macro
7579 % #3,#4\endargs@ is the list value
7580 \def\pop@
#1#2#3,
#4\endargs@
{%
7584 \long\def\longpop@
#1#2#3,
#4\endargs@
{%
7589 % This defines a Texinfo @macro. There are eight cases: recursive and
7590 % nonrecursive macros of zero, one, up to nine, and many arguments.
7591 % Much magic with \expandafter here.
7592 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
7593 % they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group.
7596 \let\hash=##
% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
7600 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7601 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
7603 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7604 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
7605 \noexpand\braceorline
7606 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname}%
7607 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname#
#1{%
7608 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
7610 \ifnum\paramno<
10\relax % at most 9
7611 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7612 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
7613 \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx
\endcsname}%
7614 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx
\endcsname#
#1{%
7615 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname #
#1,
}%
7616 \expandafter\expandafter
7618 \expandafter\expandafter
7619 \csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname
7620 \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
7622 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7623 \noexpand\getargvals@
{\the\macname}{\argl}%
7625 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.
\the\macname .body
\endcsname\temp
7626 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.
\the\macname .recurse
\endcsname\gobble
7632 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7633 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
7634 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
7636 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7637 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
7638 \noexpand\braceorline
7639 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname}%
7640 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname#
#1{%
7642 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
7643 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
7645 \ifnum\paramno<
10\relax
7646 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7647 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
7648 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx
\endcsname}%
7649 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx
\endcsname#
#1{%
7650 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname #
#1,
}%
7651 \expandafter\expandafter
7653 \expandafter\expandafter
7654 \csname\the\macname xxx
\endcsname
7657 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
7658 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
7660 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7661 \noexpand\getargvals@
{\the\macname}{\argl}%
7663 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.
\the\macname .body
\endcsname\temp
7664 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.
\the\macname .recurse
\endcsname\norecurse
7669 \catcode `\@
\texiatcatcode\relax
7671 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.
#1}}
7673 % \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a
7674 % {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole
7675 % line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence
7676 % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg).
7678 \def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=
#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
7679 \def\braceorlinexxx{%
7680 \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else
7681 \expandafter\parsearg
7686 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
7687 % sign. Make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
7689 \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
7690 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
7691 \def\aliasyyy #1=
#2\relax{%
7693 \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=
\empty
7694 \addtomacrolist{#1}%
7695 \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=
\makecsname{#2}}%
7701 \message{cross references,
}
7704 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
7705 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
7707 % @inforef is relatively simple.
7708 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**
}
7709 \def\inforefzzz #1,
#2,
#3,
#4**
{%
7710 \putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
7711 node
\samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
7713 % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
7714 % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
7715 % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
7716 % @node foo , bar , ...
7717 % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
7719 \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,
\finishnodeparse}
7721 % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
7722 % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
7723 \def\donode#1 ,
#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,
\finishnodeparse}
7724 \def\dodonode#1,
#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
7727 \let\lastnode=
\empty
7729 % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
7730 % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
7733 \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
7734 \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
7735 \global\let\lastnode=
\empty
7739 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
7741 \newcount\savesfregister
7743 \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=
\spacefactor \fi}
7744 \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=
\savesfregister \fi}
7745 \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing
}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
7747 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
7748 % anchor), which consists of three parts:
7749 % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection,
7750 % or the anchor name.
7751 % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
7752 % empty for anchors.
7753 % 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
7755 % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
7756 % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
7757 % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
7763 \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
7764 \edef\writexrdef#
#1#
#2{%
7765 \write\auxfile{@xrdef
{#1-
% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
7766 #
#1}{#
#2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
7768 \toks0 =
\expandafter{\lastsection}%
7769 \immediate \writexrdef{title
}{\the\toks0 }%
7770 \immediate \writexrdef{snt
}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
7771 \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg
}{\folio}}% will be written later, at \shipout
7776 % @xrefautosectiontitle on|off says whether @section(ing) names are used
7777 % automatically in xrefs, if the third arg is not explicitly specified.
7778 % This was provided as a "secret" @set xref-automatic-section-title
7779 % variable, now it's official.
7781 \parseargdef\xrefautomaticsectiontitle{%
7784 \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title
\endcsname
7786 \else\ifx\temp\offword
7787 \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title
\endcsname
7790 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
7791 \errmessage{Unknown @xrefautomaticsectiontitle value `
\temp',
7797 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
7798 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
7799 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
7800 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
7802 \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,
]}
7803 \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,
]}
7804 \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,
]}
7807 \newbox\printedrefnamebox
7808 \newbox\printedmanualbox
7810 \def\xrefX[#1,
#2,
#3,
#4,
#5,
#6]{\begingroup
7813 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
7814 \setbox\printedrefnamebox =
\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
7816 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
7817 \setbox\printedmanualbox =
\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
7819 % If the printed reference name (arg #3) was not explicitly given in
7820 % the @xref, figure out what we want to use.
7821 \ifdim \wd\printedrefnamebox =
0pt
7822 % No printed node name was explicitly given.
7823 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title
\endcsname \relax
7824 % Not auto section-title: use node name inside the square brackets.
7825 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
7827 % Auto section-title: use chapter/section title inside
7828 % the square brackets if we have it.
7829 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox >
0pt
7830 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it; use node name.
7831 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
7834 % We (should) know the real title if we have the xref values.
7835 \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title
}{}}%
7837 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
7838 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
7844 % Make link in pdf output.
7848 % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
7849 % etc. don't get their TeX definitions.
7852 \edef\pdfxrefdest{#1}%
7853 \txiescapepdf\pdfxrefdest
7856 \startlink attr
{/Border
[0 0 0]}%
7857 \ifnum\filenamelength>
0
7858 goto file
{\the\filename.pdf
} name
{\pdfxrefdest}%
7860 goto name
{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}%
7863 \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
7866 % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
7867 % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the
7868 % LABEL-title being set to a magic string.
7870 % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
7871 % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
7874 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
7875 \csname XR
#1-title
\endcsname
7877 \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
7878 % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
7879 % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
7880 \ifdim\wd\printedrefnamebox =
0pt
7886 % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
7888 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox >
0pt
7889 \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
7892 % node/anchor (non-float) references.
7894 % If we use \unhbox to print the node names, TeX does not insert
7895 % empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will not
7896 % find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
7897 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens,
7898 % this is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name
7899 % again, so it is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
7901 % Cross-manual reference. Only include the "Section ``foo'' in" if
7902 % the foo is neither missing or Top. Thus, @xref{,,,foo,The Foo Manual}
7903 % outputs simply "see The Foo Manual".
7904 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox >
0pt
7905 % What is the 7sp about? The idea is that we also want to omit
7906 % the Section part if we would be printing "Top", since they are
7907 % clearly trying to refer to the whole manual. But, this being
7908 % TeX, we can't easily compare strings while ignoring the possible
7909 % spaces before and after in the input. By adding the arbitrary
7910 % 7sp, we make it much less likely that a real node name would
7911 % happen to have the same width as "Top" (e.g., in a monospaced font).
7912 % I hope it will never happen in practice.
7914 % For the same basic reason, we retypeset the "Top" at every
7915 % reference, since the current font is indeterminate.
7917 \setbox\topbox =
\hbox{Top
\kern7sp}%
7918 \setbox2 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces \printedrefname \unskip \kern7sp}%
7920 \ifdim \wd2 =
\wd\topbox \else
7921 \putwordSection{} ``
\printedrefname''
\putwordin{}\space
7924 \cite{\printedmanual}%
7926 % Reference in this manual.
7928 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
7929 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
7930 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
7931 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
7932 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
7934 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
7935 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
7936 \setbox2 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt
}{}}%
7937 \ifdim \wd2 >
0pt
\refx{#1-snt
}\space\fi
7939 % output the `[mynode]' via the macro below so it can be overridden.
7940 \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
7942 % But we always want a comma and a space:
7945 % output the `page 3'.
7946 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg
}{}%
7952 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
7953 % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
7954 % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
7955 % one that Bob is working on :).
7957 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
7959 % Things referred to by \setref.
7965 \putwordChapter@tie
\the\chapno
7966 \else \ifnum\subsecno=
0
7967 \putwordSection@tie
\the\chapno.
\the\secno
7968 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=
0
7969 \putwordSection@tie
\the\chapno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno
7971 \putwordSection@tie
\the\chapno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno
7976 \putwordAppendix@tie @char
\the\appendixno{}%
7977 \else \ifnum\subsecno=
0
7978 \putwordSection@tie @char
\the\appendixno.
\the\secno
7979 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=
0
7980 \putwordSection@tie @char
\the\appendixno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno
7983 @char
\the\appendixno.
\the\secno.
\the\subsecno.
\the\subsubsecno
7987 % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME.
7988 % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
7994 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
7995 \csname XR
#1\endcsname
7998 % If not defined, say something at least.
7999 \angleleft un\-de\-fined
\angleright
8002 {\toks0 =
{#1}% avoid expansion of possibly-complex value
8003 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `
\the\toks0'.
}}%
8006 \global\warnedxrefstrue
8007 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.
}%
8012 % It's defined, so just use it.
8015 #2% Output the suffix in any case.
8018 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's
8019 % just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid
8020 % collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do.
8023 {% The node name might contain 8-bit characters, which in our current
8024 % implementation are changed to commands like @'e. Don't let these
8025 % mess up the control sequence name.
8028 \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
8031 \expandafter\gdef\csname XR
\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref
8033 % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
8034 \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR
\safexrefname\endcsname
8035 % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
8036 \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
8037 \csname floatlist
\iffloattype\endcsname
8039 % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
8040 \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
8041 \toks0 =
{\do}% yes, so just \do
8043 % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
8044 \toks0 =
\expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
8047 % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
8048 % for later use in \listoffloats.
8049 \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist
\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
8054 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
8057 \openin 1 \jobname.aux
8060 \global\havexrefstrue
8065 \def\setupdatafile{%
8066 \catcode`\^^@=
\other
8067 \catcode`\^^A=
\other
8068 \catcode`\^^B=
\other
8069 \catcode`\^^C=
\other
8070 \catcode`\^^D=
\other
8071 \catcode`\^^E=
\other
8072 \catcode`\^^F=
\other
8073 \catcode`\^^G=
\other
8074 \catcode`\^^H=
\other
8075 \catcode`\^^K=
\other
8076 \catcode`\^^L=
\other
8077 \catcode`\^^N=
\other
8078 \catcode`\^^P=
\other
8079 \catcode`\^^Q=
\other
8080 \catcode`\^^R=
\other
8081 \catcode`\^^S=
\other
8082 \catcode`\^^T=
\other
8083 \catcode`\^^U=
\other
8084 \catcode`\^^V=
\other
8085 \catcode`\^^W=
\other
8086 \catcode`\^^X=
\other
8087 \catcode`\^^Z=
\other
8088 \catcode`\^^
[=
\other
8089 \catcode`\^^\=
\other
8090 \catcode`\^^
]=
\other
8091 \catcode`\^^^=
\other
8092 \catcode`\^^_=
\other
8093 % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
8094 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
8095 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
8096 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
8097 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat
8098 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first
8099 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could
8100 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't.
8102 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat:
8103 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
8104 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
8108 % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
8121 \catcode`+=
\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
8123 % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
8124 % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
8125 % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
8126 % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
8127 % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
8128 % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
8129 % now. --karl, 15jan04.
8132 % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters.
8136 \catcode\count1=
\other
8137 \advance\count1 by
1
8138 \ifnum \count1<
256 \loop \fi
8142 % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
8148 \def\readdatafile#1{%
8155 \message{insertions,
}
8156 % including footnotes.
8158 \newcount \footnoteno
8160 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
8161 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
8162 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
8163 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
8164 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
8165 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -
20000\footnoteno =
0 }
8167 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for Info output only.
8168 \let\footnotestyle=
\comment
8172 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
8174 \let\indent=
\ptexindent
8175 \let\noindent=
\ptexnoindent
8176 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
8177 \edef\thisfootno{$^
{\the\footnoteno}$
}%
8179 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
8180 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
8182 \ifhmode\edef\@sf
{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
8184 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
8190 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
8191 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
8193 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
8194 % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
8195 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
8198 \insert\footins\bgroup
8199 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
8200 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
8201 % So reset some parameters.
8203 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
8204 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
8205 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
8206 \floatingpenalty\@MM
8211 \parindent\defaultparindent
8215 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
8216 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
8217 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
8218 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
8219 \let\noindent =
\relax
8221 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
8222 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
8223 \everypar =
{\hang}%
8224 \textindent{\thisfootno}%
8226 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
8227 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
8228 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
8231 % Invoke rest of plain TeX footnote routine.
8232 \futurelet\next\fo@t
8234 }%end \catcode `\@=11
8236 % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
8237 % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
8239 % Similarly, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
8240 % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
8241 % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
8243 % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
8244 % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
8247 \def\startsavinginserts{%
8248 \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
8249 \let\insert\saveinsert
8251 \let\checkinserts\relax
8255 % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
8256 % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
8259 \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
8260 \afterassignment\next
8261 % swallow the left brace
8264 \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE
\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
8265 \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 =
\vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
8267 \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
8269 \def\placesaveins#1{%
8270 \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
8274 % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
8276 \def\dospecials{\do S
\do A
\do V
\do E
} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
8277 \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE
{}
8281 \def\newsaveins #1{%
8282 \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
8285 \def\newsaveinsX #1{%
8286 \csname newbox
\endcsname #1%
8287 \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
8292 \let\checkinserts\empty
8297 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
8298 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
8300 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
8301 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
8302 % undone and the next image would fail.
8303 \openin 1 = epsf.tex
8305 % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
8306 % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
8307 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 =
}%
8312 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
8313 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf
8314 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
8315 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
8316 it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.
}
8319 \ifx\epsfbox\thisiundefined
8320 \ifwarnednoepsf \else
8321 \errhelp =
\noepsfhelp
8322 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored
}%
8323 \global\warnednoepsftrue
8326 \imagexxx #1,,,,,
\finish
8330 % Arguments to @image:
8331 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
8332 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
8333 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
8334 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
8335 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing stuff.
8337 \def\imagexxx#1,
#2,
#3,
#4,
#5,
#6\finish{\begingroup
8338 \catcode`\^^M =
5 % in case we're inside an example
8339 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
8340 % If the image is by itself, center it.
8344 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
8345 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
8347 \nobreak\vskip\parskip
8351 % Leave vertical mode so that indentation from an enclosing
8352 % environment such as @quotation is respected. On the other hand, if
8353 % it's at the top level, we don't want the normal paragraph indentation.
8358 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
8360 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
8361 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 >
0pt
\epsfxsize=
#2\relax \fi
8362 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 >
0pt
\epsfysize=
#3\relax \fi
8366 \ifimagevmode \medskip \fi % space after the standalone image
8370 % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
8371 % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
8372 % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
8374 \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,
\finish}
8376 % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
8377 \def\eatcommaspace#1,
{#1,
}
8379 % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
8380 % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
8381 % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
8383 % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
8386 % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
8387 % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
8389 % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
8390 % chapter-level command.
8391 \let\resetallfloatnos=
\empty
8393 \def\dofloat#1,
#2,
#3,
#4\finish{%
8394 \let\thiscaption=
\empty
8395 \let\thisshortcaption=
\empty
8397 % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
8399 % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
8400 % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
8404 % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
8409 \def\floatlabel{#2}%
8410 \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
8412 \ifx\floattype\empty
8413 \let\safefloattype=
\empty
8416 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
8417 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
8420 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
8424 % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
8425 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
8426 % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
8427 % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
8429 \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno
\endcsname
8430 \global\advance\floatno by
1
8433 % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the
8434 % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
8435 % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
8436 % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
8439 \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=
\safefloattype}%
8440 \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat
}%
8444 % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
8447 % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
8448 \restorefirstparagraphindent
8451 % we have these possibilities:
8452 % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
8453 % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
8454 % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
8455 % @float Foo & no caption: Foo
8456 % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
8457 % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
8458 % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
8459 % @float & no caption:
8462 \let\floatident =
\empty
8464 % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
8465 \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
8467 % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
8468 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
8469 \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
8470 \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
8473 \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
8476 % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
8477 % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
8478 \let\captionline =
\floatident
8480 \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
8481 \ifx\floatident\empty \else
8482 \appendtomacro\captionline{:
}% had ident, so need a colon between
8486 \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
8489 % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
8490 % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
8491 \ifx\captionline\empty \else
8495 % Space below caption.
8499 % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
8500 % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
8501 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
8502 % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
8503 % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
8504 % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
8508 % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M
8509 % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so
8510 % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file.
8512 \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{%
8513 \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
8520 \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef
{\floatlabel-lof
}{\floatident
8521 \ifx\gtemp\empty \else :
\gtemp \fi}}%
8524 \egroup % end of \vtop
8526 % place the captured inserts
8528 % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning
8529 % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly
8530 % float. --kasal, 26may04
8535 % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
8537 \def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
8538 \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
8541 % @caption, @shortcaption
8543 \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
8544 \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
8545 \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
8546 \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
8548 % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
8549 % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
8552 % Haven't seen this figure type before.
8553 \csname newcount
\endcsname #1%
8555 % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
8556 \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
8557 \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=
0 }%
8562 % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
8563 % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
8564 % first read the @float command.
8566 \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie
\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
8568 % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
8569 % distinguish floats from other xref types.
8570 \def\floatmagic{!!float!!
}
8572 % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
8573 % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
8574 % \lastsection value which we \setref above.
8576 \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==
\finish}
8578 % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
8579 % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
8581 \def\doiffloat#1=
#2=
#3\finish{%
8583 \def\iffloattype{#2}%
8584 \ifx\temp\floatmagic
8587 % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
8589 \parseargdef\listoffloats{%
8590 \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
8592 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
8593 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
8596 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
8599 % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
8600 \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist
\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
8602 % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
8603 \message{\linenumber No `
\safefloattype' floats to list.
}%
8607 \leftskip=
\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
8608 \let\do=
\listoffloatsdo
8609 \csname floatlist
\safefloattype\endcsname
8614 % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
8615 % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
8616 % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
8617 % has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
8619 % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
8620 % they won't appear in the aux file).
8622 \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
8623 \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title
\finish{{%
8624 % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
8625 % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
8626 % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
8628 \toksA =
\expandafter{\csname XR
#1-lof
\endcsname}%
8630 % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
8631 \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR
#1-pg
\endcsname}}%
8636 \message{localization,
}
8638 % For single-language documents, @documentlanguage is usually given very
8639 % early, just after @documentencoding. Single argument is the language
8640 % (de) or locale (de_DE) abbreviation.
8643 \catcode`
\_ =
\active
8645 \parseargdef\documentlanguage{\begingroup
8646 \let_=
\normalunderscore % normal _ character for filenames
8647 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
8648 % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
8649 \openin 1 txi-
#1.tex
8651 \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore{#1_
\finish}%
8653 \globaldefs =
1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
8657 \endgroup % end raw TeX
8660 % If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
8663 \gdef\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_
#2\finish{%
8664 \openin 1 txi-
#1.tex
8666 \errhelp =
\nolanghelp
8667 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-
#1.tex
}%
8669 \globaldefs =
1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
8674 }% end of special _ catcode
8676 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
8677 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? Putting it in the current
8678 directory should work if nowhere else does.
}
8680 % This macro is called from txi-??.tex files; the first argument is the
8681 % \language name to set (without the "\lang@" prefix), the second and
8682 % third args are \{left,right}hyphenmin.
8684 % The language names to pass are determined when the format is built.
8685 % See the etex.log file created at that time, e.g.,
8686 % /usr/local/texlive/2008/texmf-var/web2c/pdftex/etex.log.
8688 % With TeX Live 2008, etex now includes hyphenation patterns for all
8689 % available languages. This means we can support hyphenation in
8690 % Texinfo, at least to some extent. (This still doesn't solve the
8691 % accented characters problem.)
8694 \def\txisetlanguage#1#2#3{%
8695 % do not set the language if the name is undefined in the current TeX.
8696 \expandafter\ifx\csname lang@
#1\endcsname \relax
8697 \message{no patterns for
#1}%
8699 \global\language =
\csname lang@
#1\endcsname
8701 % but there is no harm in adjusting the hyphenmin values regardless.
8702 \global\lefthyphenmin =
#2\relax
8703 \global\righthyphenmin =
#3\relax
8706 % Helpers for encodings.
8707 % Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
8709 \def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
8711 \loop\ifnum\count255<
256
8712 \global\catcode\count255=
#1\relax
8713 \advance\count255 by
1
8717 \def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{%
8719 \loop\ifnum\count255<
256
8720 \catcode\count255=
#1\relax
8721 \advance\count255 by
1
8725 % @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
8726 % according to the specified encoding.
8728 \parseargdef\documentencoding{%
8729 % Encoding being declared for the document.
8730 \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc
\endcsname}%
8732 % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
8733 % to compare them with \ifx.
8734 \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc
\endcsname}%
8735 \def\latnine{\csname ISO-
8859-
15.enc
\endcsname}%
8736 \def\latone{\csname ISO-
8859-
1.enc
\endcsname}%
8737 \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-
8859-
2.enc
\endcsname}%
8738 \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-
8.enc
\endcsname}%
8740 \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
8743 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
8744 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8747 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
8748 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8751 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
8752 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8755 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
8756 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8760 \message{Unknown
document encoding
#1, ignoring.
}%
8769 % A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
8770 % the default font encoding (OT1).
8772 \def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing in OT1 encoding:
#1.
}}
8774 % Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
8775 \def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,
{#1}\fi}
8777 % First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
8778 % correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
8779 % macros containing the character definitions.
8780 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8782 % Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
8783 \def\latonechardefs{%
8785 \gdef^^a1
{\exclamdown}
8786 \gdef^^a2
{\missingcharmsg{CENT SIGN
}}
8787 \gdef^^a3
{{\pounds}}
8788 \gdef^^a4
{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN
}}
8789 \gdef^^a5
{\missingcharmsg{YEN SIGN
}}
8790 \gdef^^a6
{\missingcharmsg{BROKEN BAR
}}
8793 \gdef^^a9
{\copyright}
8795 \gdef^^ab
{\guillemetleft}
8798 \gdef^^ae
{\registeredsymbol}
8801 \gdef^^b0
{\textdegree}
8810 \gdef^^b8
{\cedilla\
}
8814 \gdef^^bb
{\guillemetright}
8815 \gdef^^bc
{$
1\over4$
}
8816 \gdef^^bd
{$
1\over2$
}
8817 \gdef^^be
{$
3\over4$
}
8818 \gdef^^bf
{\questiondown}
8825 \gdef^^c5
{\ringaccent A
}
8827 \gdef^^c7
{\cedilla C
}
8859 \gdef^^e5
{\ringaccent a
}
8861 \gdef^^e7
{\cedilla c
}
8866 \gdef^^ec
{\`
{\dotless i
}}
8867 \gdef^^ed
{\'
{\dotless i
}}
8868 \gdef^^ee
{\^
{\dotless i
}}
8869 \gdef^^ef
{\"
{\dotless i
}}
8889 % Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
8890 \def\latninechardefs{%
8891 % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
8904 % Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
8905 \def\lattwochardefs{%
8907 \gdef^^a1
{\ogonek{A
}}
8910 \gdef^^a4
{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN
}}
8916 \gdef^^aa
{\cedilla S
}
8921 \gdef^^af
{\dotaccent Z
}
8923 \gdef^^b0
{\textdegree}
8924 \gdef^^b1
{\ogonek{a
}}
8925 \gdef^^b2
{\ogonek{ }}
8931 \gdef^^b8
{\cedilla\
}
8933 \gdef^^ba
{\cedilla s
}
8938 \gdef^^bf
{\dotaccent z
}
8947 \gdef^^c7
{\cedilla C
}
8950 \gdef^^ca
{\ogonek{E
}}
8966 \gdef^^d9
{\ringaccent U
}
8971 \gdef^^de
{\cedilla T
}
8981 \gdef^^e7
{\cedilla c
}
8984 \gdef^^ea
{\ogonek{e
}}
8987 \gdef^^ed
{\'
{\dotless{i
}}}
8988 \gdef^^ee
{\^
{\dotless{i
}}}
9000 \gdef^^f9
{\ringaccent u
}
9005 \gdef^^fe
{\cedilla t
}
9006 \gdef^^ff
{\dotaccent{}}
9009 % UTF-8 character definitions.
9011 % This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
9012 % changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by
9013 % permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
9019 \gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
9020 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:
#1\string #2\endcsname}
9022 \gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
9023 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:
#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
9025 \gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
9026 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:
#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
9028 \gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
9030 \message{\linenumber Unicode char
\string #1 not defined for Texinfo
}%
9041 \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
9042 \uccode`\~
\countUTFx
9043 \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
9044 \advance\countUTFx by
1
9045 \ifnum\countUTFx <
\countUTFy
9046 \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
9052 \xdef~
{\noexpand\UTFviiiTwoOctets\string~
}}
9058 \xdef~
{\noexpand\UTFviiiThreeOctets\string~
}}
9064 \xdef~
{\noexpand\UTFviiiFourOctets\string~
}}
9077 \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacter#1#2{%
9078 \countUTFz = "
#1\relax
9079 %\wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+#1 (decimal \the\countUTFz)}%
9082 \def\UTFviiiTwoOctets#
#1#
#2{%
9083 \csname u8:#
#1\string #
#2\endcsname}%
9084 \def\UTFviiiThreeOctets#
#1#
#2#
#3{%
9085 \csname u8:#
#1\string #
#2\string #
#3\endcsname}%
9086 \def\UTFviiiFourOctets#
#1#
#2#
#3#
#4{%
9087 \csname u8:#
#1\string #
#2\string #
#3\string #
#4\endcsname}%
9088 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
9089 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
9090 \gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
9093 \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
9094 \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0
\relax
9095 \errhelp =
\EMsimple
9096 \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value <
00A0
}%
9097 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "
800\relax
9099 \parseUTFviiiB C
\UTFviiiTwoOctets.,
%
9100 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "
10000\relax
9103 \parseUTFviiiB E
\UTFviiiThreeOctets.
{,;
}%
9108 \parseUTFviiiB F
\UTFviiiFourOctets.
{!,;
}%
9112 \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
9113 \countUTFx =
\countUTFz
9114 \divide\countUTFz by
64
9115 \countUTFy =
\countUTFz
9116 \multiply\countUTFz by
64
9117 \advance\countUTFx by -
\countUTFz
9118 \advance\countUTFx by
128
9119 \uccode `
#1\countUTFx
9120 \countUTFz =
\countUTFy}
9122 \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
9123 \advance\countUTFz by "
#10\relax
9124 \uccode `
#3\countUTFz
9125 \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
9128 \def\utfeightchardefs{%
9129 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0
}{\tie}
9130 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1
}{\exclamdown}
9131 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3
}{\pounds}
9132 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8
}{\"
{ }}
9133 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9
}{\copyright}
9134 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA
}{\ordf}
9135 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB
}{\guillemetleft}
9136 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD
}{\-
}
9137 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE
}{\registeredsymbol}
9138 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF
}{\=
{ }}
9140 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0
}{\ringaccent{ }}
9141 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4
}{\'
{ }}
9142 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8
}{\cedilla{ }}
9143 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA
}{\ordm}
9144 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB
}{\guillemetright}
9145 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF
}{\questiondown}
9147 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0
}{\`A
}
9148 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1
}{\'A
}
9149 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2
}{\^A
}
9150 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3
}{\~A
}
9151 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4
}{\"A
}
9152 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5
}{\AA}
9153 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6
}{\AE}
9154 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7
}{\cedilla{C
}}
9155 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8
}{\`E
}
9156 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9
}{\'E
}
9157 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA
}{\^E
}
9158 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB
}{\"E
}
9159 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC
}{\`I
}
9160 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD
}{\'I
}
9161 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE
}{\^I
}
9162 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF
}{\"I
}
9164 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D0
}{\DH}
9165 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1
}{\~N
}
9166 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2
}{\`O
}
9167 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3
}{\'O
}
9168 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4
}{\^O
}
9169 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5
}{\~O
}
9170 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6
}{\"O
}
9171 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8
}{\O}
9172 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9
}{\`U
}
9173 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA
}{\'U
}
9174 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB
}{\^U
}
9175 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC
}{\"U
}
9176 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD
}{\'Y
}
9177 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DE
}{\TH}
9178 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF
}{\ss}
9180 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0
}{\`a
}
9181 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1
}{\'a
}
9182 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2
}{\^a
}
9183 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3
}{\~a
}
9184 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4
}{\"a
}
9185 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5
}{\aa}
9186 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6
}{\ae}
9187 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7
}{\cedilla{c
}}
9188 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8
}{\`e
}
9189 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9
}{\'e
}
9190 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA
}{\^e
}
9191 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB
}{\"e
}
9192 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC
}{\`
{\dotless{i
}}}
9193 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED
}{\'
{\dotless{i
}}}
9194 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE
}{\^
{\dotless{i
}}}
9195 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF
}{\"
{\dotless{i
}}}
9197 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F0
}{\dh}
9198 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1
}{\~n
}
9199 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2
}{\`o
}
9200 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3
}{\'o
}
9201 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4
}{\^o
}
9202 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5
}{\~o
}
9203 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6
}{\"o
}
9204 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8
}{\o}
9205 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9
}{\`u
}
9206 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA
}{\'u
}
9207 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB
}{\^u
}
9208 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC
}{\"u
}
9209 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD
}{\'y
}
9210 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FE
}{\th}
9211 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF
}{\"y
}
9213 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A
}
9214 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a
}
9215 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A
}}
9216 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a
}}
9217 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0104}{\ogonek{A
}}
9218 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0105}{\ogonek{a
}}
9219 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C
}
9220 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c
}
9221 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C
}
9222 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c
}
9223 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0118}{\ogonek{E
}}
9224 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0119}{\ogonek{e
}}
9225 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A
}{\dotaccent{C
}}
9226 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B
}{\dotaccent{c
}}
9227 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C
}{\v{C
}}
9228 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D
}{\v{c
}}
9229 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E
}{\v{D
}}
9231 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E
}
9232 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e
}
9233 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E
}}
9234 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e
}}
9235 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E
}}
9236 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e
}}
9237 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A
}{\v{E
}}
9238 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B
}{\v{e
}}
9239 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C
}{\^G
}
9240 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D
}{\^g
}
9241 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E
}{\u{G
}}
9242 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F
}{\u{g
}}
9244 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G
}}
9245 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g
}}
9246 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H
}
9247 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h
}
9248 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I
}
9249 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~
{\dotless{i
}}}
9250 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A
}{\=I
}
9251 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B
}{\=
{\dotless{i
}}}
9252 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C
}{\u{I
}}
9253 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D
}{\u{\dotless{i
}}}
9255 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I
}}
9256 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i
}}
9257 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ
}
9258 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij
}
9259 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J
}
9260 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^
{\dotless{j
}}}
9261 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L
}
9262 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A
}{\'l
}
9264 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}
9265 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}
9266 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N
}
9267 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n
}
9268 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N
}}
9269 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n
}}
9270 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C
}{\=O
}
9271 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D
}{\=o
}
9272 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E
}{\u{O
}}
9273 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F
}{\u{o
}}
9275 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O
}}
9276 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o
}}
9277 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}
9278 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}
9279 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R
}
9280 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r
}
9281 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R
}}
9282 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r
}}
9283 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A
}{\'S
}
9284 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B
}{\'s
}
9285 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C
}{\^S
}
9286 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D
}{\^s
}
9287 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E
}{\cedilla{S
}}
9288 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F
}{\cedilla{s
}}
9290 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S
}}
9291 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s
}}
9292 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{t
}}
9293 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{T
}}
9294 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T
}}
9296 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U
}
9297 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u
}
9298 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A
}{\=U
}
9299 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B
}{\=u
}
9300 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C
}{\u{U
}}
9301 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D
}{\u{u
}}
9302 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E
}{\ringaccent{U
}}
9303 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F
}{\ringaccent{u
}}
9305 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U
}}
9306 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u
}}
9307 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W
}
9308 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w
}
9309 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y
}
9310 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y
}
9311 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y
}
9312 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z
}
9313 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A
}{\'z
}
9314 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B
}{\dotaccent{Z
}}
9315 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C
}{\dotaccent{z
}}
9316 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D
}{\v{Z
}}
9317 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E
}{\v{z
}}
9319 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4
}{D
\v{Z
}}
9320 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5
}{D
\v{z
}}
9321 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6
}{d
\v{z
}}
9322 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7
}{LJ
}
9323 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8
}{Lj
}
9324 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9
}{lj
}
9325 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA
}{NJ
}
9326 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB
}{Nj
}
9327 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC
}{nj
}
9328 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD
}{\v{A
}}
9329 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE
}{\v{a
}}
9330 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF
}{\v{I
}}
9332 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0
}{\v{\dotless{i
}}}
9333 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1
}{\v{O
}}
9334 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2
}{\v{o
}}
9335 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3
}{\v{U
}}
9336 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4
}{\v{u
}}
9338 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2
}{\=
{\AE}}
9339 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3
}{\=
{\ae}}
9340 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6
}{\v{G
}}
9341 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7
}{\v{g
}}
9342 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8
}{\v{K
}}
9343 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9
}{\v{k
}}
9345 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0
}{\v{\dotless{j
}}}
9346 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1
}{DZ
}
9347 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2
}{Dz
}
9348 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3
}{dz
}
9349 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4
}{\'G
}
9350 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5
}{\'g
}
9351 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8
}{\`N
}
9352 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9
}{\`n
}
9353 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC
}{\'
{\AE}}
9354 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD
}{\'
{\ae}}
9355 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE
}{\'
{\O}}
9356 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF
}{\'
{\o}}
9358 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E
}{\v{H
}}
9359 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F
}{\v{h
}}
9361 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A
}}
9362 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a
}}
9363 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E
}}
9364 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e
}}
9365 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E
}{\dotaccent{O
}}
9366 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F
}{\dotaccent{o
}}
9368 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y
}
9369 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y
}
9370 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j
}}
9372 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02DB
}{\ogonek{ }}
9374 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02
}{\dotaccent{B
}}
9375 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03
}{\dotaccent{b
}}
9376 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04
}{\udotaccent{B
}}
9377 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05
}{\udotaccent{b
}}
9378 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06
}{\ubaraccent{B
}}
9379 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07
}{\ubaraccent{b
}}
9380 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A
}{\dotaccent{D
}}
9381 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B
}{\dotaccent{d
}}
9382 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C
}{\udotaccent{D
}}
9383 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D
}{\udotaccent{d
}}
9384 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E
}{\ubaraccent{D
}}
9385 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F
}{\ubaraccent{d
}}
9387 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E
}{\dotaccent{F
}}
9388 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F
}{\dotaccent{f
}}
9390 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20
}{\=G
}
9391 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21
}{\=g
}
9392 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22
}{\dotaccent{H
}}
9393 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23
}{\dotaccent{h
}}
9394 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24
}{\udotaccent{H
}}
9395 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25
}{\udotaccent{h
}}
9396 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26
}{\"H
}
9397 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27
}{\"h
}
9399 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30
}{\'K
}
9400 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31
}{\'k
}
9401 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32
}{\udotaccent{K
}}
9402 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33
}{\udotaccent{k
}}
9403 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34
}{\ubaraccent{K
}}
9404 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35
}{\ubaraccent{k
}}
9405 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36
}{\udotaccent{L
}}
9406 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37
}{\udotaccent{l
}}
9407 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A
}{\ubaraccent{L
}}
9408 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B
}{\ubaraccent{l
}}
9409 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E
}{\'M
}
9410 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F
}{\'m
}
9412 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40
}{\dotaccent{M
}}
9413 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41
}{\dotaccent{m
}}
9414 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42
}{\udotaccent{M
}}
9415 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43
}{\udotaccent{m
}}
9416 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44
}{\dotaccent{N
}}
9417 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45
}{\dotaccent{n
}}
9418 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46
}{\udotaccent{N
}}
9419 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47
}{\udotaccent{n
}}
9420 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48
}{\ubaraccent{N
}}
9421 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49
}{\ubaraccent{n
}}
9423 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54
}{\'P
}
9424 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55
}{\'p
}
9425 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56
}{\dotaccent{P
}}
9426 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57
}{\dotaccent{p
}}
9427 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58
}{\dotaccent{R
}}
9428 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59
}{\dotaccent{r
}}
9429 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A
}{\udotaccent{R
}}
9430 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B
}{\udotaccent{r
}}
9431 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E
}{\ubaraccent{R
}}
9432 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F
}{\ubaraccent{r
}}
9434 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60
}{\dotaccent{S
}}
9435 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61
}{\dotaccent{s
}}
9436 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62
}{\udotaccent{S
}}
9437 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63
}{\udotaccent{s
}}
9438 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A
}{\dotaccent{T
}}
9439 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B
}{\dotaccent{t
}}
9440 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C
}{\udotaccent{T
}}
9441 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D
}{\udotaccent{t
}}
9442 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E
}{\ubaraccent{T
}}
9443 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F
}{\ubaraccent{t
}}
9445 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C
}{\~V
}
9446 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D
}{\~v
}
9447 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E
}{\udotaccent{V
}}
9448 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F
}{\udotaccent{v
}}
9450 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80
}{\`W
}
9451 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81
}{\`w
}
9452 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82
}{\'W
}
9453 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83
}{\'w
}
9454 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84
}{\"W
}
9455 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85
}{\"w
}
9456 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86
}{\dotaccent{W
}}
9457 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87
}{\dotaccent{w
}}
9458 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88
}{\udotaccent{W
}}
9459 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89
}{\udotaccent{w
}}
9460 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A
}{\dotaccent{X
}}
9461 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B
}{\dotaccent{x
}}
9462 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C
}{\"X
}
9463 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D
}{\"x
}
9464 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E
}{\dotaccent{Y
}}
9465 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F
}{\dotaccent{y
}}
9467 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90
}{\^Z
}
9468 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91
}{\^z
}
9469 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92
}{\udotaccent{Z
}}
9470 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93
}{\udotaccent{z
}}
9471 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94
}{\ubaraccent{Z
}}
9472 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95
}{\ubaraccent{z
}}
9473 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96
}{\ubaraccent{h
}}
9474 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97
}{\"t
}
9475 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98
}{\ringaccent{w
}}
9476 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99
}{\ringaccent{y
}}
9478 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0
}{\udotaccent{A
}}
9479 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1
}{\udotaccent{a
}}
9481 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8
}{\udotaccent{E
}}
9482 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9
}{\udotaccent{e
}}
9483 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC
}{\~E
}
9484 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD
}{\~e
}
9486 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA
}{\udotaccent{I
}}
9487 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB
}{\udotaccent{i
}}
9488 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC
}{\udotaccent{O
}}
9489 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD
}{\udotaccent{o
}}
9491 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4
}{\udotaccent{U
}}
9492 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5
}{\udotaccent{u
}}
9494 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2
}{\`Y
}
9495 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3
}{\`y
}
9496 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4
}{\udotaccent{Y
}}
9498 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8
}{\~Y
}
9499 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9
}{\~y
}
9501 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--
}
9502 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---
}
9503 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft}
9504 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright}
9505 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A
}{\quotesinglbase}
9506 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C
}{\quotedblleft}
9507 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D
}{\quotedblright}
9508 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E
}{\quotedblbase}
9509 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet}
9510 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots}
9511 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft}
9512 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A
}{\guilsinglright}
9513 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC
}{\euro}
9515 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion}
9516 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2
}{\result}
9518 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus}
9519 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\point}
9520 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv}
9521 }% end of \utfeightchardefs
9524 % US-ASCII character definitions.
9525 \def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
9529 % Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with
9530 % existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a
9531 % document encoding.
9533 \setnonasciicharscatcode \other
9536 \message{formatting,
}
9538 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent =
15pt
9540 \chapheadingskip =
15pt plus
4pt minus
2pt
9541 \secheadingskip =
12pt plus
3pt minus
2pt
9542 \subsecheadingskip =
9pt plus
2pt minus
2pt
9544 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
9547 % Don't be very finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
9550 % Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans.
9554 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
9555 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
9556 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
9557 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
9559 \def\setemergencystretch{%
9560 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
9561 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
9562 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
9564 \emergencystretch =
.15\hsize
9568 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
9569 % 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
9570 % 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
9572 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
9573 % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
9575 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
9578 \splittopskip =
\topskip
9581 \advance\vsize by
\topskip
9582 \outervsize =
\vsize
9583 \advance\outervsize by
2\topandbottommargin
9584 \pageheight =
\vsize
9587 \outerhsize =
\hsize
9588 \advance\outerhsize by
0.5in
9591 \normaloffset =
#4\relax
9592 \bindingoffset =
#5\relax
9595 \pdfpageheight #7\relax
9596 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
9597 % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of
9598 % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with.
9599 \pdfhorigin =
1 true in
9600 \pdfvorigin =
1 true in
9603 \setleading{\textleading}
9605 \parindent =
\defaultparindent
9606 \setemergencystretch
9609 % @letterpaper (the default).
9610 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs =
1
9611 \parskip =
3pt plus
2pt minus
1pt
9612 \textleading =
13.2pt
9614 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
9615 \internalpagesizes{607.2pt
}{6in
}% that's 46 lines
9617 {\bindingoffset}{36pt
}%
9621 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
9622 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs =
1
9623 \parskip =
2pt plus
1pt
9626 \internalpagesizes{7.5in
}{5in
}%
9628 {\bindingoffset}{16pt
}%
9631 \lispnarrowing =
0.3in
9634 \contentsrightmargin =
0pt
9635 \defbodyindent =
.5cm
9638 % Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
9639 % (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
9640 \def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs =
1
9641 \parskip =
1.5pt plus
1pt
9644 \internalpagesizes{7.4in
}{4.8in
}%
9649 \lispnarrowing =
0.25in
9652 \contentsrightmargin =
0pt
9653 \defbodyindent =
.4cm
9656 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
9657 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs =
1
9658 \parskip =
3pt plus
2pt minus
1pt
9659 \textleading =
13.2pt
9661 % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
9662 % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
9663 % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
9664 % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
9665 % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
9666 % your texinfo source file like this:
9668 % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
9669 % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
9671 \internalpagesizes{673.2pt
}{160mm
}% that's 51 lines
9672 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
9673 {\bindingoffset}{44pt
}%
9678 \contentsrightmargin =
0pt
9679 \defbodyindent =
5mm
9682 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
9683 % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
9684 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
9685 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs =
1
9686 \parskip =
2pt plus
1pt minus
0.1pt
9687 \textleading =
12.5pt
9689 \internalpagesizes{160mm
}{120mm
}%
9690 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
9691 {\bindingoffset}{8pt
}%
9694 \lispnarrowing =
0.2in
9697 \contentsrightmargin =
0pt
9698 \defbodyindent =
2mm
9702 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
9703 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs =
1
9705 \internalpagesizes{237mm
}{150mm
}%
9707 {\bindingoffset}{7mm
}%
9710 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
9714 % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
9715 \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs =
1
9717 \internalpagesizes{241mm
}{165mm
}%
9718 {\voffset}{-
2.95mm
}%
9719 {\bindingoffset}{7mm
}%
9724 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
9725 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
9726 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
9728 \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,
\finish}
9729 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,
#2,
#3\finish{{%
9730 \setbox0 =
\hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 >
0pt
\hsize=
#2\relax \fi
9733 \parskip =
3pt plus
2pt minus
1pt
9734 \setleading{\textleading}%
9737 \advance\dimen0 by
\voffset
9740 \advance\dimen2 by
\normaloffset
9742 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
9743 {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
9744 {\bindingoffset}{44pt
}%
9748 % Set default to letter.
9753 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.
}
9755 \def^^L
{\par} % remove \outer, so ^L can appear in an @comment
9757 % DEL is a comment character, in case @c does not suffice.
9760 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
9761 \catcode`\"=
\other \def\normaldoublequote{"
}
9762 \catcode`\$=
\other \def\normaldollar{$
}%$ font-lock fix
9763 \catcode`\+=
\other \def\normalplus{+
}
9764 \catcode`\<=
\other \def\normalless{<
}
9765 \catcode`\>=
\other \def\normalgreater{>
}
9766 \catcode`\^=
\other \def\normalcaret{^
}
9767 \catcode`
\_=
\other \def\normalunderscore{_
}
9768 \catcode`\|=
\other \def\normalverticalbar{|
}
9769 \catcode`\~=
\other \def\normaltilde{~
}
9771 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
9772 % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
9773 % where something hairier probably needs to be done.
9775 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
9776 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
9777 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
9778 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
9780 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=
0pt
#1\else #2\fi}
9782 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
9783 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
9784 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
9785 % this is not a problem.
9786 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>
0pt
#1\else #2\fi}
9788 % Turn off all special characters except @
9789 % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary).
9790 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
9791 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
9794 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
9795 \let"=
\activedoublequote
9797 \def~
{{\tt\char126}}
9803 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
9805 % Subroutine for the previous macro.
9806 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em
\vbox{\hrule width
.3em height
.1ex
}\kern .07em
}
9809 \def|
{{\tt\char124}}
9817 \def+
{{\tt \char 43}}
9819 \def$
{\ifusingit{{\sl\$
}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
9821 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
9822 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
9823 % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on.
9824 % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file.
9825 \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=
\other \catcode`
\_=
\other}
9827 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
9829 \def\turnoffactive{%
9830 \normalturnoffactive
9836 % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
9838 \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
9839 \global\let\rawbackslashxx=
\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
9841 % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
9842 % \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
9843 {\catcode`\\=
\other @gdef@realbackslash
{\
} @gdef@doublebackslash
{\\
}}
9845 % In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
9846 % in fixed width font.
9847 \catcode`\\=
\active % @ for escape char from now on.
9849 % The story here is that in math mode, the \char of \backslashcurfont
9850 % ends up printing the roman \ from the math symbol font (because \char
9851 % in math mode uses the \mathcode, and plain.tex sets
9852 % \mathcode`\\="026E). It seems better for @backslashchar{} to always
9853 % print a typewriter backslash, hence we use an explicit \mathchar,
9854 % which is the decimal equivalent of "715c (class 7, e.g., use \fam;
9855 % ignored family value; char position "5C). We can't use " for the
9856 % usual hex value because it has already been made active.
9857 @def@normalbackslash
{{@tt @ifmmode @mathchar29020 @else @backslashcurfont @fi
}}
9858 @let@backslashchar = @normalbackslash
% @backslashchar{} is for user documents.
9860 % On startup, @fixbackslash assigns:
9861 % @let \ = @normalbackslash
9862 % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
9863 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
9864 % catcode other. We switch back and forth between these.
9865 @gdef@rawbackslash
{@let\=@backslashcurfont
}
9866 @gdef@otherbackslash
{@let\=@realbackslash
}
9868 % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
9869 % the literal character `\'.
9871 @def@normalturnoffactive
{%
9872 @let"=@normaldoublequote
9873 @let$=@normaldollar
%$ font-lock fix
9876 @let>=@normalgreater
9877 @let\=@normalbackslash
9879 @let_=@normalunderscore
9880 @let|=@normalverticalbar
9882 @markupsetuplqdefault
9883 @markupsetuprqdefault
9887 % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily.
9888 % This is canceled by @fixbackslash.
9891 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
9892 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
9895 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo
{@fixbackslash
}
9896 @global@let\ = @eatinput
9898 % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then
9899 % the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
9900 % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur.
9901 % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
9902 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
9904 @gdef@fixbackslash
{%
9905 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi
9910 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
9913 % These (along with & and #) are made active for url-breaking, so need
9914 % active definitions as the normal characters.
9919 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
9920 % @hashchar{} gets its own user-level command, because of #line.
9921 @catcode`@& = @other @def@normalamp
{&
}
9922 @catcode`@# = @other @def@normalhash
{#
}
9923 @catcode`@
% = @other @def@normalpercent{%}
9925 @let @hashchar = @normalhash
9927 @c Finally, make ` and ' active, so that txicodequoteundirected and
9928 @c txicodequotebacktick work right in, e.g., @w
{@code
{`foo'
}}. If we
9929 @c don't make ` and ' active, @code will not get them as active chars.
9930 @c Do this last of all since we use ` in the previous @catcode assignments.
9933 @markupsetuplqdefault
9934 @markupsetuprqdefault
9937 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
9938 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\
\message"
9939 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\
\texinfoversion{"
9940 @c time-stamp-format: "
%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
9941 @c time-stamp-end: "
}"
9947 arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-
0b2efa2ea115